blob: 41d710529e65d9292af476f4a420dee199434009 [file] [log] [blame]
Bram Moolenaar34cc7d82021-09-21 20:09:51 +02001*options.txt* For Vim version 8.2. Last change: 2021 Sep 21
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002
3
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
5
6
7Options *options*
8
91. Setting options |set-option|
102. Automatically setting options |auto-setting|
113. Options summary |option-summary|
12
Bram Moolenaar2ec618c2016-10-01 14:47:05 +020013For an overview of options see quickref.txt |option-list|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000014
15Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to
16achieve special effects. These options come in three forms:
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle*
18 number has a numeric value
19 string has a string value
20
21==============================================================================
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +0000221. Setting options *set-option* *E764*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000023
24 *:se* *:set*
Bram Moolenaar6b915c02020-01-18 15:53:19 +010025:se[t][!] Show all options that differ from their default value.
26 When [!] is present every option is on a separate
27 line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000028
Bram Moolenaar6b915c02020-01-18 15:53:19 +010029:se[t][!] all Show all but terminal options.
30 When [!] is present every option is on a separate
31 line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000032
33:se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the
34 key codes are not shown, because they are generated
35 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal
36 codes in the GUI is not useful either...
37
38 *E518* *E519*
39:se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}.
40
41:se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on.
42 Number option: show value.
43 String option: show value.
44
45:se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off.
46
Bram Moolenaar00a927d2010-05-14 23:24:24 +020047 *:set-!* *:set-inv*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000048:se[t] {option}! or
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +020049:se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000050
51 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim*
52:se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +020053 current value of 'compatible'.
54:se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value.
55:se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000056
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +010057:se[t] all& Set all options to their default value. The values of
Bram Moolenaar88774fd2015-08-25 19:52:04 +020058 these options are not changed:
59 all terminal options, starting with t_
60 'columns'
61 'cryptmethod'
62 'encoding'
63 'key'
64 'lines'
65 'term'
66 'ttymouse'
67 'ttytype'
68 Warning: This may have a lot of side effects.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000069
70 *:set-args* *E487* *E521*
71:se[t] {option}={value} or
72:se[t] {option}:{value}
73 Set string or number option to {value}.
74 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal,
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +010075 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0').
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000076 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by
77 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is
78 set). See |cmdline-completion|.
79 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and
80 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value}
81 is not allowed.
82 See |option-backslash| for using white space and
83 backslashes in {value}.
84
85:se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=*
86 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the
87 {value} to a string option. When the option is a
88 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
89 value was empty.
90 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +000091 are removed. When adding a flag that was already
92 present the option value doesn't change.
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +000093 Also see |:set-args| above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000094
95:se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=*
96 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend
97 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a
98 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
99 value was empty.
100 Also see |:set-args| above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000101
102:se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=*
103 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove
104 the {value} from a string option, if it is there.
105 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there
106 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma
107 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option
108 becomes empty.
109 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be
110 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags
111 one by one to avoid problems.
112 Also see |:set-args| above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000113
114The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: >
115 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3
116If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given
117and the following arguments will be ignored.
118
119 *:set-verbose*
120When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it
121was last set. Example: >
122 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent?
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +0200123< shiftwidth=4 ~
124 Last set from modeline line 1 ~
125 cindent ~
126 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim line 30 ~
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000127This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":verbose
128set all" or ":verbose set" without an argument.
129When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000130When the option was set while executing a function, user command or
131autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported.
132Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting
133'compatible'.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000134A few special texts:
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +0200135 Last set from modeline line 1 ~
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000136 Option was set in a |modeline|.
137 Last set from --cmd argument ~
138 Option was set with command line argument |--cmd| or +.
139 Last set from -c argument ~
140 Option was set with command line argument |-c|, +, |-S| or
141 |-q|.
142 Last set from environment variable ~
143 Option was set from an environment variable, $VIMINIT,
144 $GVIMINIT or $EXINIT.
145 Last set from error handler ~
146 Option was cleared when evaluating it resulted in an error.
147
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +0200148{not available when compiled without the |+eval| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000149
150 *:set-termcap* *E522*
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +0000151For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000152override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If
153the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: >
154 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot
155This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For
156example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: >
157 :set <M-b>=^[b
158(the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it)
159The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations.
160
Bram Moolenaar0b2f94d2011-03-22 14:35:05 +0100161You can define any key codes, e.g.: >
162 :set t_xy=^[foo;
163There is no warning for using a name that isn't recognized. You can map these
164codes as you like: >
165 :map <t_xy> something
166< *E846*
167When a key code is not set, it's like it does not exist. Trying to get its
168value will result in an error: >
169 :set t_kb=
170 :set t_kb
171 E846: Key code not set: t_kb
172
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +0000173The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
174security reasons.
175
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000176The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000177at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000178"set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the
179|more-prompt|.
180
181 *option-backslash*
182To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a
183backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this
184means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded
185down).
186A few examples: >
187 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags"
188 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file"
189 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file"
190
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000191The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To
192include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000193'titlestring' option to "hi|there": >
194 :set titlestring=hi\|there
195This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": >
196 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there
197
Bram Moolenaar89a9c152021-08-29 21:55:35 +0200198Similarly, in legacy script the double quote character starts a comment. To
199include the '"' in the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the
200'titlestring' option to 'hi "there"': >
Bram Moolenaar7df351e2006-01-23 22:30:28 +0000201 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\"
202
Bram Moolenaar89a9c152021-08-29 21:55:35 +0200203In |Vim9| script it's simpler, comments start with a '#' character, and only
204when preceded by white space. A backslash is needed less often: >
205 vim9script
206 set titlestring=hi\ "there"
207 set titlestring=hi#there#
208 set titlestring=hi\ \#there#
209
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +0100210For Win32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More precise: For
211options that expect a file name (those where environment variables are
212expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not removed. But
213a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma, etc.) is used
214like explained above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000215There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": >
216 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path"
217 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path"
218 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!)
219For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes
220are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000221halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000222result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it.
223
224 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags*
225 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552*
226Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an
227option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: >
228 :set guioptions+=a
229Remove a flag from an option like this: >
230 :set guioptions-=a
231This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000232Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000233the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba"
234doesn't appear.
235
236 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var*
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +0000237Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000238environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable
239name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name
240are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may
241follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is
242appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: >
243 :set term=$TERM.new
244 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,.
245When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set
246opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing.
247
248
249Handling of local options *local-options*
250
251Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +0100252has its own copy of this option, thus each can have its own value. This
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000253allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set
254'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another.
255
256The following explains what happens to these local options in specific
257situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses
258the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user
259expects is a bit complicated...
260
261When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus
262right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same.
263
264When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since
265the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer,
266these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a
267global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and
268global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed,
269thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer.
270
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +0200271When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the options from the window
272that was last closed are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this
273window, the values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the
274last closed window where the buffer was edited last are used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000275
276It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer.
277When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep
278using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the
279local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window
280has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but
281global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: >
282 :e one
283 :set list
284 :e two
285Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list"
286command you have also set the global value. >
287 :set nolist
288 :e one
289 :setlocal list
290 :e two
291Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global
292value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the
293global value. Note that if you do this next: >
294 :e one
Bram Moolenaar531da592013-05-06 05:58:55 +0200295You will get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited "one".
296The options local to a window are remembered for each buffer. This also
297happens when the buffer is not loaded, but they are lost when the buffer is
298wiped out |:bwipe|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000299
300 *:setl* *:setlocal*
Bram Moolenaar6b915c02020-01-18 15:53:19 +0100301:setl[ocal][!] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000302 current buffer or window. Not all options have a
303 local value. If the option does not have a local
304 value the global value is set.
Bram Moolenaarc3301872010-07-25 20:53:06 +0200305 With the "all" argument: display local values for all
306 local options.
307 Without argument: Display local values for all local
308 options which are different from the default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000309 When displaying a specific local option, show the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000310 local value. For a global/local boolean option, when
311 the global value is being used, "--" is displayed
312 before the option name.
313 For a global option the global value is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000314 shown (but that might change in the future).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000315
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000316:setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by
317 copying the value.
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000318
Bram Moolenaar6be7f872012-01-20 21:08:56 +0100319:se[t] {option}< For |global-local| options: Remove the local value of
320 {option}, so that the global value will be used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000321
322 *:setg* *:setglobal*
Bram Moolenaar6b915c02020-01-18 15:53:19 +0100323:setg[lobal][!] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000324 option without changing the local value.
325 When displaying an option, the global value is shown.
Bram Moolenaarc3301872010-07-25 20:53:06 +0200326 With the "all" argument: display global values for all
327 local options.
328 Without argument: display global values for all local
329 options which are different from the default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000330
331For buffer-local and window-local options:
332 Command global value local value ~
333 :set option=value set set
334 :setlocal option=value - set
335:setglobal option=value set -
336 :set option? - display
337 :setlocal option? - display
338:setglobal option? display -
339
340
341Global options with a local value *global-local*
342
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +0000343Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows.
344For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value.
345You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then
346use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global
347value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000348
349For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global
350'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: >
351 :set makeprg=gmake
352then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set
353the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too.
354However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000355another 'makeprg' for it, without changing the value used for the C source
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000356files. You use this command: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000357 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake
358You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: >
359 :setlocal makeprg=
Bram Moolenaar314dd792019-02-03 15:27:20 +0100360This only works for a string option. For a number or boolean option you need
361to use the "<" flag, like this: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000362 :setlocal autoread<
Bram Moolenaar314dd792019-02-03 15:27:20 +0100363Note that for non-boolean and non-number options using "<" copies the global
364value to the local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value
365(that matters when the global value changes later). You can also use: >
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000366 :set path<
367This will make the local value of 'path' empty, so that the global value is
368used. Thus it does the same as: >
369 :setlocal path=
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000370Note: In the future more global options can be made global-local. Using
371":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then.
372
373
374Setting the filetype
375
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +0200376:setf[iletype] [FALLBACK] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000377 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if
378 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands.
379 This is short for: >
380 :if !did_filetype()
381 : setlocal filetype={filetype}
382 :endif
383< This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid
384 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different
385 settings and syntax files to be loaded.
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +0200386
387 When the optional FALLBACK argument is present, a
388 later :setfiletype command will override the
Bram Moolenaar26967612019-03-17 17:13:16 +0100389 'filetype'. This is to be used for filetype
390 detections that are just a guess. |did_filetype()|
391 will return false after this command.
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +0200392
Bram Moolenaard58e9292011-02-09 17:07:58 +0100393 *option-window* *optwin*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000394:bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options*
395:opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options.
396 Options are grouped by function.
397 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the
398 short help to open a help window with more help for
399 the option.
400 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the
401 "set" line to set the new value. For window and
402 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is
403 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help
404 window, in which case the window below help window is
405 used (skipping the option-window).
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +0100406 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
407 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000408
409 *$HOME*
410Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an
411option and after a space or comma.
412
413On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory
414of user "user". Example: >
415 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,.
416
417On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can
418contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the
419"gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'.
420
421NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set"
422command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let".
423
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +0200424 *$HOME-windows*
425On MS-Windows, if $HOME is not defined as an environment variable, then
426at runtime Vim will set it to the expansion of $HOMEDRIVE$HOMEPATH.
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200427If $HOMEDRIVE is not set then $USERPROFILE is used.
428
429This expanded value is not exported to the environment, this matters when
430running an external command: >
431 :echo system('set | findstr ^HOME=')
432and >
433 :echo luaeval('os.getenv("HOME")')
434should echo nothing (an empty string) despite exists('$HOME') being true.
435When setting $HOME to a non-empty string it will be exported to the
436subprocesses.
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +0200437
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000438
439Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on
440the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
441
442 *:fix* *:fixdel*
443:fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD':
444 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~
445 CTRL-? CTRL-H
446 not CTRL-? CTRL-?
447
Bram Moolenaar82be4842021-01-11 19:40:15 +0100448 (CTRL-? is 0o177 octal, 0x7f hex)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000449
450 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the
451 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in
452 your .vimrc: >
453 :fixdel
454< This works no matter what the actual code for
455 backspace is.
456
457 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can
458 use this: >
459 :if &term == "termname"
460 : set t_kb=^V<BS>
461 : fixdel
462 :endif
463< Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000464 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000465 with your terminal name.
466
467 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not
468 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: >
469 :if &term == "termname"
470 : set t_kD=^V<Delete>
471 :endif
472< Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key
473 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname"
474 with your terminal name.
475
476 *Linux-backspace*
477 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key
478 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by
479 putting this line in your rc.local: >
480 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys
481<
482 *NetBSD-backspace*
483 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce
484 the right code, try this: >
485 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace"
486< If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: >
487 keysym 22 = BackSpace
488< You need to restart for this to take effect.
489
490==============================================================================
4912. Automatically setting options *auto-setting*
492
493Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives
494to set options automatically for one or more files:
495
4961. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See
497 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions,
498 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started.
499 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and
500 |:mksession|.
5012. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed.
502 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and
503 many other things. See |autocommand|.
5043. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a
505 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for
506 modelines. This is explained here.
507
508 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520*
509There are two forms of modelines. The first form:
Bram Moolenaar664f3cf2019-12-07 16:03:51 +0100510 [text{white}]{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000511
Bram Moolenaar664f3cf2019-12-07 16:03:51 +0100512[text{white}] empty or any text followed by at least one blank
513 character (<Space> or <Tab>); "ex:" always requires at
514 least one blank character
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200515{vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200516[white] optional white space
517{options} a list of option settings, separated with white space
518 or ':', where each part between ':' is the argument
519 for a ":set" command (can be empty)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000520
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200521Examples:
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000522 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6 ~
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200523 vim: tw=77 ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000524
525The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi):
526
Bram Moolenaarade0d392020-01-21 22:33:58 +0100527 [text{white}]{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text]
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000528
Bram Moolenaarade0d392020-01-21 22:33:58 +0100529[text{white}] empty or any text followed by at least one blank
530 character (<Space> or <Tab>); "ex:" always requires at
531 least one blank character
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200532{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:", "Vim:" or "ex:"
533[white] optional white space
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200534se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space); When
535 "Vim" is used it must be "set".
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200536{options} a list of options, separated with white space, which
537 is the argument for a ":set" command
538: a colon
539[text] any text or empty
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000540
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200541Examples:
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000542 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200543 /* Vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000544
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200545The white space before {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the
546chance that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception:
547"vi:" and "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with
548version 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this
549could be short for "example:").
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000550
Hu Jialun9dcd3492021-08-28 20:42:50 +0200551If the modeline is disabled within a modeline, subsequent modelines will be
552ignored. This is to allow turning off modeline on a per-file basis. This is
553useful when a line looks like a modeline but isn't. For example, it would be
554good to start a YAML file containing strings like "vim:" with
555 # vim: nomodeline ~
556so as to avoid modeline misdetection. Following options on the same line
557after modeline deactivation, if any, are still evaluated (but you would
558normally not have any).
559
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000560 *modeline-local*
561The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +0000562buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global
563options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and
564the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result
565depends on which one was opened last.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000566
Bram Moolenaar15d0a8c2004-09-06 17:44:46 +0000567When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options
568from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local
569option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer
570in another window. But window-local options will be set.
571
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000572 *modeline-version*
573If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200574number can be specified where "vim:" or "Vim:" is used:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000575 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later
576 vim<{vers}: version before {vers}
577 vim={vers}: version {vers}
578 vim>{vers}: version after {vers}
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +0100579{vers} is 700 for Vim 7.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor).
580For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 7.0:
581 /* vim700: set foldmethod=marker */ ~
582To use a modeline for Vim after version 7.2:
583 /* vim>702: set cole=2: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000584There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":".
585
586
587The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option.
588If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked.
589
590Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000591like:
592 /* vi:ts=4: */ ~
593will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK:
594 /* vi:set ts=4: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000595
596If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped.
597
598If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000599backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example:
Bram Moolenaar95a9dd12019-12-19 22:12:03 +0100600 /* vi:set fillchars=stl\:^,vert\:\|: */ ~
601This sets the 'fillchars' option to "stl:^,vert:\|". Only a single backslash
602before the ':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:".
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +0200603 *E992*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000604No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +0000605might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines). And not all options
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +0200606can be set. For some options a flag is set, so that when the value is used
607the |sandbox| is effective. Some options can only be set from the modeline
608when 'modelineexpr' is set (the default is off).
609
610Still, there is always a small risk that a modeline causes trouble. E.g.,
611when some joker sets 'textwidth' to 5 all your lines are wrapped unexpectedly.
612So disable modelines before editing untrusted text. The mail ftplugin does
613this, for example.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000614
615Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could
616define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For
617example: >
618 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif
619And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing
620"VAR".
621
622==============================================================================
6233. Options summary *option-summary*
624
625In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with
626an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used.
627
628In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option"
629is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used.
630
631For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is
632used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when
633'compatible' is set.
634
635Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000636are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000637different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in
638one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view
639at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain
640file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example
641the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C
642program.
643
644 global one option for all buffers and windows
645 local to window each window has its own copy of this option
646 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option
647
648When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window
649are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the
650buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the
651'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for
652buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000653first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer
654is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000655present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the
656buffer is created.
657
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +0000658Hidden options *hidden-options*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000659
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +0000660Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported
661features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces
662below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an
663error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden
664option though, it is not stored.
665
666To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: >
667 if exists('&foo')
668This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really
669supported use something like this: >
670 if exists('+foo')
671<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000672 *E355*
673A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
674
675 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph*
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +0100676'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-Windows, 224 otherwise)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000677 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000678 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
679 feature}
680 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The
681 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode
682 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_)
683 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26].
684 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8.
685 See |rileft.txt|.
686
687 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'*
688'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off)
689 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000690 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
691 feature}
692 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to
693 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get
694 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See
695 'revins'.
696 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
697
698 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'*
699'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off)
700 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000701 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi|
702 feature}
Bram Moolenaar14184a32019-02-16 15:10:30 +0100703 This option was for using Farsi, which has been removed. See
704 |farsi.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000705
706 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'*
707'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single")
708 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000709 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding.
710 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class
711 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek
712 letters, Cyrillic letters).
713
714 There are currently two possible values:
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000715 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000716 expected by most users.
717 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters.
Bram Moolenaar5c3bd0a2010-08-04 20:55:44 +0200718 *E834* *E835*
719 The value "double" cannot be used if 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar1c6737b2020-09-07 22:18:52 +0200720 contains a character that would be double width.
Bram Moolenaar08aac3c2020-08-28 21:04:24 +0200721
722 The values are overruled for characters specified with
723 |setcellwidths()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000724
725 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for
726 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in
727 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro,
728 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000729 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000730 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000731 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000732 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font
733 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.),
734 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived
735 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +0100736 to be set to "double" under CJK MS-Windows when the system locale is
737 set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode Standard Annex #11
738 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000739
Bram Moolenaarac7bd632013-03-19 11:35:58 +0100740 Vim may set this option automatically at startup time when Vim is
741 compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and if |t_u7| is set to the
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200742 escape sequence to request cursor position report. The response can
743 be found in |v:termu7resp|.
Bram Moolenaarac7bd632013-03-19 11:35:58 +0100744
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000745 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'*
746'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off)
747 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000748 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +0200749 on macOS}
750 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on macOS
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000751 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts,
752 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays.
753 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set
754 to its default (empty string).
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +0100755 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000756
757 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'*
758'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off)
759 global
Bram Moolenaar00a927d2010-05-14 23:24:24 +0200760 {only available when compiled with it, use
761 exists("+autochdir") to check}
Bram Moolenaard8c00872005-07-22 21:52:15 +0000762 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
763 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window.
764 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened
765 or selected.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +0000766 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000767
Bram Moolenaar8b9abfd2021-03-29 20:49:05 +0200768 *'autoshelldir'* *'asd'* *'noautoshelldir'* *'noasd'*
769'autoshelldir' 'asd' boolean (default off)
770 global
771 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
772 change the directory of the shell running in a terminal window. You
773 need proper setting-up, so whenever the shell's pwd changes an OSC 7
774 escape sequence will be emitted. For example, on Linux, you can source
775 /etc/profile.d/vte.sh in your shell profile if you use bash or zsh.
776
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000777 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'*
778'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off)
779 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000780 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
781 feature}
782 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text.
783 Setting this option will:
784 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
785 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
786 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles
787 between typing English and Arabic key mapping.
788 - Set the 'delcombine' option
789 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text.
790
791 Resetting this option will:
792 - Reset the 'rightleft' option.
793 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value).
794 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +0200795 option).
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +0100796 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000797 Also see |arabic.txt|.
798
799 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'*
800 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'*
801'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on)
802 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000803 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
804 feature}
805 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character
806 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +0200807 take effect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000808 one which encompasses:
809 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location
810 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone).
811 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters
812 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +0100813 When disabled the display shows each character's true stand-alone
814 form.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000815 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for
816 further details see |arabic.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +0100817 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000818
819 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'*
820'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off)
821 local to buffer
822 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR>
823 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not
824 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000825 <Esc>, CTRL-O or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor
826 to another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included
827 in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000828 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you
829 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first
830 line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000831 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in
832 a different way.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +0200833 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and
834 restored when 'paste' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000835
836 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'*
837'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off)
838 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000839 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and
840 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again.
Bram Moolenaarfd358112018-07-07 23:21:31 +0200841 When the file has been deleted this is not done, so you have the text
842 from before it was deleted. When it appears again then it is read.
843 |timestamp|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000844 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to
845 using the global value: >
846 :set autoread<
847<
848 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'*
849'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off)
850 global
851 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each
852 :next, :rewind, :last, :first, :previous, :stop, :suspend, :tag, :!,
Bram Moolenaar14716812006-05-04 21:54:08 +0000853 :make, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when a :buffer, CTRL-O, CTRL-I,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000854 '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one to another file.
855 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see
856 'autowriteall' for that.
Bram Moolenaar93a1df22018-09-10 11:51:50 +0200857 Some buffers will not be written, specifically when 'buftype' is
Bram Moolenaar20aac6c2018-09-02 21:07:30 +0200858 "nowrite", "nofile", "terminal" or "prompt".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000859
860 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'*
861'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off)
862 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000863 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit",
864 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window.
865 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has
866 been set.
867
868 *'background'* *'bg'*
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +0200869'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light", see below)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000870 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000871 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a
872 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that
873 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal.
874 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used.
875 This will not always be correct.
876 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim
877 what the background color looks like. For changing the background
878 color, see |:hi-normal|.
879
880 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000881 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000882 change. *g:colors_name*
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +0100883 When a color scheme is loaded (the "g:colors_name" variable is set)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000884 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If
885 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work.
886 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +0100887 be undone. First delete the "g:colors_name" variable when needed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000888
889 When setting 'background' to the default value with: >
890 :set background&
891< Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly,
892 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value.
Bram Moolenaar2e693a82019-10-16 22:35:02 +0200893 If the GUI supports a dark theme, you can use the "d" flag in
Bram Moolenaar50bf7ce2019-09-15 13:17:00 +0200894 'guioptions', see 'go-d'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000895
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200896 When the |t_RB| option is set, Vim will use it to request the background
Bram Moolenaarb4d6c3e2017-05-27 16:45:17 +0200897 color from the terminal. If the returned RGB value is dark/light and
898 'background' is not dark/light, 'background' will be set and the
899 screen is redrawn. This may have side effects, make t_BG empty in
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200900 your .vimrc if you suspect this problem. The response to |t_RB| can
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +0100901 be found in |v:termrbgresp|.
Bram Moolenaarb4d6c3e2017-05-27 16:45:17 +0200902
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000903 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be
904 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects
905 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to
906 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read
907 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background
908 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by
909 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value
910 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on").
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +0200911
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +0100912 For MS-Windows the default is "dark".
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +0200913 For other systems "dark" is used when 'term' is "linux",
914 "screen.linux", "cygwin" or "putty", or $COLORFGBG suggests a dark
915 background. Otherwise the default is "light".
916
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +0200917 The |:terminal| command and the |term_start()| function use the
918 'background' value to decide whether the terminal window will start
919 with a white or black background.
920
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000921 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly
922 depending on the terminal name. Example: >
923 :if &term == "pcterm"
924 : set background=dark
925 :endif
926< When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups
927 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER
928 the setting of the 'background' option.
929 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file
930 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this
931 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be
932 done with ":syntax on".
933
934 *'backspace'* *'bs'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +0200935'backspace' 'bs' string (default "", set to "indent,eol,start"
936 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000937 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000938 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert
939 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows
940 a way to backspace over something:
941 value effect ~
942 indent allow backspacing over autoindent
943 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines)
944 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U
945 stop once at the start of insert.
Bram Moolenaaraa0489e2020-04-17 19:41:21 +0200946 nostop like start, except CTRL-W and CTRL-U do not stop at the start of
947 insert.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000948
949 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used.
950
951 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier:
952 value effect ~
953 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible)
954 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol"
955 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start"
Bram Moolenaaraa0489e2020-04-17 19:41:21 +0200956 3 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,nostop"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000957
958 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want.
959 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
960
961 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'*
962'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off)
963 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000964 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the
965 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the
966 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being
967 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is
968 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000969 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000970 |backup-table| for more explanations.
971 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
972 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the
973 oldest version of a file.
974 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
975
976 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'*
977'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto")
Bram Moolenaarb8ee25a2014-09-23 15:45:08 +0200978 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000979 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's
980 done. This is a comma separated list of words.
981
982 The main values are:
983 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one
984 "no" rename the file and write a new one
985 "auto" one of the previous, what works best
986
987 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are:
988 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing
989 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing
990
991 Making a copy and overwriting the original file:
992 - Takes extra time to copy the file.
993 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or
994 has a resource fork, all this is preserved.
995 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link,
996 not of the real file.
997
998 Renaming the file and writing a new one:
999 + It's fast.
1000 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new
1001 file.
1002 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link.
1003
1004 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming file
1005 is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001006 the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected, a
1007 copy will be made.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001008
1009 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in
1010 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they
1011 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing
1012 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to
1013 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be
1014 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or
1015 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not
1016 be propagated back to the original source.
1017 *crontab*
1018 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program
1019 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if
1020 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001021 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001022 example.
1023
1024 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled
1025 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and
1026 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001027 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001028 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this
1029 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for
1030 others.
1031
1032 When the file is renamed this is the other way around: The backup has
1033 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file
1034 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic)
1035 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't
1036 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly
1037 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but
1038 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will
1039 again not rename the file.
1040
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001041 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
1042 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
1043
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001044 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'*
1045'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01001046 for Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:/tmp,c:/temp"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001047 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/")
1048 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001049 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas.
1050 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01001051 where this is possible. The directory must exist, Vim will not
1052 create it for you.
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01001053 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ('patchmode' is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001054 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this.
1055 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory
1056 as the edited file.
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01001057 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-Windows) means to put
1058 the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The leading
1059 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001060 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning).
1061 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
1062 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
1063 name, precede it with a backslash.
1064 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
1065 - A directory name may end in an '/'.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02001066 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//",
Bram Moolenaarf0d58ef2018-11-16 16:13:44 +01001067 the backup file name will be built from the complete path to the
1068 file with all path separators changed to percent '%' signs. This
1069 will ensure file name uniqueness in the backup directory.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02001070 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a
1071 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will
1072 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to
1073 use '//', instead of '\\'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001074 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
1075 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
1076 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
1077 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
1078< - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
1079 of the option is removed.
1080 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options.
1081 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: >
1082 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp
1083< You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your
1084 home directory for this to work properly.
1085 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
1086 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
1087 uses another default.
1088 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1089 security reasons.
1090
1091 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589*
1092'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_")
1093 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001094 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the
1095 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids
1096 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might
1097 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with
1098 ".bak" that you want to keep.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00001099 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001100
Bram Moolenaar3fdfa4a2004-10-07 21:02:47 +00001101 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre
1102 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to
1103 include a timestamp. >
1104 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' . strftime("%Y%b%d%X") . '~'
1105< Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory.
1106
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001107 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'*
Bram Moolenaarb8e22a02018-04-12 21:37:34 +02001108'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*"
1109 Unix: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*"
1110 Mac: "/private/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001111 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001112 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
1113 feature}
1114 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the
1115 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both
1116 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used.
1117 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
1118 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|.
1119 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00001120 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001121
Bram Moolenaar1aeaf8c2012-05-18 13:46:39 +02001122 WARNING: Not having a backup file means that when Vim fails to write
1123 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
1124 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only disable
1125 backups if you don't care about losing the file.
1126
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001127 Note that environment variables are not expanded. If you want to use
1128 $HOME you must expand it explicitly, e.g.: >
Bram Moolenaar7c1c6db2016-04-03 22:08:05 +02001129 :let &backupskip = escape(expand('$HOME'), '\') . '/tmp/*'
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001130
1131< Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00001132 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see
1133 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001134
1135 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'*
1136'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600)
1137 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001138 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
1139 feature}
1140 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|.
1141
1142 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'*
1143'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off)
1144 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001145 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001146 feature}
Bram Moolenaar51b0f372017-11-18 18:52:04 +01001147 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the GUI.
1148
1149 *'balloonevalterm'* *'bevalterm'* *'noballoonevalterm'*
1150 *'nobevalterm'*
1151'balloonevalterm' 'bevalterm' boolean (default off)
1152 global
Bram Moolenaar51b0f372017-11-18 18:52:04 +01001153 {only available when compiled with the
1154 |+balloon_eval_term| feature}
1155 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the terminal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001156
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001157 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'*
1158'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar9b2200a2006-03-20 21:55:45 +00001159 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001160 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
1161 feature}
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00001162 Expression for text to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used
Bram Moolenaara6c27c42019-05-09 19:16:22 +02001163 when 'ballooneval' or 'balloonevalterm' is on. These variables can be
1164 used:
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001165
1166 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show
1167 v:beval_winnr number of the window
Bram Moolenaar82af8712016-06-04 20:20:29 +02001168 v:beval_winid ID of the window
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001169 v:beval_lnum line number
1170 v:beval_col column number (byte index)
1171 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer
1172
Bram Moolenaar54775062019-07-31 21:07:14 +02001173 Instead of showing a balloon, which is limited to plain text, consider
1174 using a popup window, see |popup_beval_example|. A popup window can
1175 use highlighting and show a border.
1176
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001177 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects!
1178 Example: >
Bram Moolenaara6c27c42019-05-09 19:16:22 +02001179 function MyBalloonExpr()
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00001180 return 'Cursor is at line ' . v:beval_lnum .
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001181 \', column ' . v:beval_col .
1182 \ ' of file ' . bufname(v:beval_bufnr) .
1183 \ ' on word "' . v:beval_text . '"'
1184 endfunction
1185 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr()
1186 set ballooneval
1187<
Bram Moolenaar396e8292019-07-13 23:04:31 +02001188 Also see |balloon_show()|, it can be used if the content of the balloon
1189 is to be fetched asynchronously. In that case evaluating
1190 'balloonexpr' should result in an empty string. If you get a balloon
1191 with only "0" you probably didn't return anything from your function.
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001192
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001193 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text
1194 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty,
1195 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans
1196 or Sun Workshop).
1197
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001198 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
1199 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02001200 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00001201
1202 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
Bram Moolenaar396e8292019-07-13 23:04:31 +02001203 evaluating 'balloonexpr', see |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00001204
Bram Moolenaar87e25fd2005-07-27 21:13:01 +00001205 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: >
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00001206 if has("balloon_multiline")
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00001207< When they are supported "\n" characters will start a new line. If the
1208 expression evaluates to a |List| this is equal to using each List item
1209 as a string and putting "\n" in between them.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001210 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00001211
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001212 *'belloff'* *'bo'*
1213'belloff' 'bo' string (default "")
1214 global
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001215 Specifies for which events the bell will not be rung. It is a comma
1216 separated list of items. For each item that is present, the bell
1217 will be silenced. This is most useful to specify specific events in
1218 insert mode to be silenced.
1219
1220 item meaning when present ~
1221 all All events.
1222 backspace When hitting <BS> or <Del> and deleting results in an
1223 error.
1224 cursor Fail to move around using the cursor keys or
1225 <PageUp>/<PageDown> in |Insert-mode|.
1226 complete Error occurred when using |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K| or
1227 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|.
1228 copy Cannot copy char from insert mode using |i_CTRL-Y| or
1229 |i_CTRL-E|.
1230 ctrlg Unknown Char after <C-G> in Insert mode.
1231 error Other Error occurred (e.g. try to join last line)
1232 (mostly used in |Normal-mode| or |Cmdline-mode|).
1233 esc hitting <Esc> in |Normal-mode|.
1234 ex In |Visual-mode|, hitting |Q| results in an error.
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01001235 hangul Ignored.
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001236 insertmode Pressing <Esc> in 'insertmode'.
1237 lang Calling the beep module for Lua/Mzscheme/TCL.
1238 mess No output available for |g<|.
1239 showmatch Error occurred for 'showmatch' function.
1240 operator Empty region error |cpo-E|.
1241 register Unknown register after <C-R> in |Insert-mode|.
1242 shell Bell from shell output |:!|.
1243 spell Error happened on spell suggest.
1244 wildmode More matches in |cmdline-completion| available
1245 (depends on the 'wildmode' setting).
1246
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001247 This is most useful to fine tune when in Insert mode the bell should
1248 be rung. For Normal mode and Ex commands, the bell is often rung to
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001249 indicate that an error occurred. It can be silenced by adding the
1250 "error" keyword.
1251
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001252 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'*
1253'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off)
1254 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001255 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also
1256 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few
1257 options will be changed (also when it already was on):
1258 'textwidth' will be set to 0
1259 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0
1260 'modeline' will be off
1261 'expandtab' will be off
1262 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the
1263 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL>
1264 separates lines).
1265 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the
1266 file is read without conversion.
1267 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is
1268 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g.,
1269 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set
1270 'bin' again when the file has been loaded.
1271 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when
1272 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of
1273 saved option values.
1274 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument.
1275 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all
1276 files you edit.
1277 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if
1278 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to
1279 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See
1280 the 'endofline' option.
1281
1282 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'*
1283'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on)
1284 global
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02001285 {only for MS-DOS}
Bram Moolenaarf3913272016-02-25 00:00:01 +01001286 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001287
1288 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'*
1289'bomb' boolean (default off)
1290 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001291 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte
1292 Order Mark) is prepended to the file:
1293 - this option is on
1294 - the 'binary' option is off
1295 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big
1296 endian variants.
1297 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file.
1298 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it
1299 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01001300 appear halfway the resulting file. Gcc doesn't accept a BOM.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001301 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a
1302 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly.
1303 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you
1304 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM
1305 will be restored when writing the file.
1306
1307 *'breakat'* *'brk'*
1308'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?")
1309 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02001310 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001311 feature}
1312 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line
Bram Moolenaarac6e65f2005-08-29 22:25:38 +00001313 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit
1314 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001315
Bram Moolenaar7c1c6db2016-04-03 22:08:05 +02001316 *'breakindent'* *'bri'* *'nobreakindent'* *'nobri'*
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001317'breakindent' 'bri' boolean (default off)
1318 local to window
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001319 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
1320 feature}
1321 Every wrapped line will continue visually indented (same amount of
1322 space as the beginning of that line), thus preserving horizontal blocks
1323 of text.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001324 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001325
1326 *'breakindentopt'* *'briopt'*
1327'breakindentopt' 'briopt' string (default empty)
1328 local to window
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001329 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
1330 feature}
1331 Settings for 'breakindent'. It can consist of the following optional
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02001332 items and must be separated by a comma:
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001333 min:{n} Minimum text width that will be kept after
1334 applying 'breakindent', even if the resulting
1335 text should normally be narrower. This prevents
1336 text indented almost to the right window border
1337 occupying lot of vertical space when broken.
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02001338 shift:{n} After applying 'breakindent', the wrapped line's
1339 beginning will be shifted by the given number of
1340 characters. It permits dynamic French paragraph
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001341 indentation (negative) or emphasizing the line
1342 continuation (positive).
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01001343 sbr Display the 'showbreak' value before applying the
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001344 additional indent.
Maxim Kimf674b352021-07-22 11:46:59 +02001345 list:{n} Adds an additional indent for lines that match a
Christian Brabandt4a0b85a2021-07-14 20:00:27 +02001346 numbered or bulleted list (using the
1347 'formatlistpat' setting).
Maxim Kimf674b352021-07-22 11:46:59 +02001348 list:-1 Uses the length of a match with 'formatlistpat'
1349 for indentation.
Christian Brabandt4a0b85a2021-07-14 20:00:27 +02001350 The default value for min is 20, shift and list is 0.
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001351
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001352 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'*
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00001353'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001354 global
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02001355 {only for Motif, Athena, GTK, Mac and Win32 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001356 Which directory to use for the file browser:
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001357 last Use same directory as with last file browser, where a
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02001358 file was opened or saved.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001359 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer.
1360 current Use the current directory.
1361 {path} Use the specified directory
1362
1363 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'*
1364'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "")
1365 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001366 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer
1367 displayed in a window:
1368 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option
1369 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), also when 'hidden'
1370 is not set
1371 unload unload the buffer, also when 'hidden' is set or using
1372 |:hide|
1373 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, also when
1374 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
1375 |:bdelete|
1376 wipe wipe out the buffer from the buffer list, also when
1377 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
1378 |:bwipeout|
1379
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001380 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01001381 are lost without a warning. Also, these values may break autocommands
1382 that switch between buffers temporarily.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001383 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify
1384 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
1385
1386 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85*
1387'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on)
1388 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001389 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If
1390 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc.
1391 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember
1392 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer.
1393 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer".
1394
1395 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382*
1396'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "")
1397 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001398 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer:
1399 <empty> normal buffer
1400 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be
1401 written
1402 nowrite buffer which will not be written
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001403 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01001404 autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001405 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001406 or list of locations |:lwindow|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001407 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this
1408 manually)
Bram Moolenaar1f2903c2017-07-23 19:51:01 +02001409 terminal buffer for a |terminal| (you are not supposed to set
1410 this manually)
Bram Moolenaarf2732452018-06-03 14:47:35 +02001411 prompt buffer where only the last line can be edited, meant
1412 to be used by a plugin, see |prompt-buffer|
1413 {only when compiled with the |+channel| feature}
Bram Moolenaar4d784b22019-05-25 19:51:39 +02001414 popup buffer used in a popup window, see |popup|.
1415 {only when compiled with the |+textprop| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001416
1417 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to
1418 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
Bram Moolenaarebdf3c92020-02-15 21:41:42 +01001419 Also see |win_gettype()|, which returns the type of the window.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001420
1421 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects!
1422
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001423 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location
1424 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and
1425 you are not supposed to change it.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001426
1427 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar:
1428 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't
1429 work (":w filename" does work though).
1430 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|.
1431 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for
1432 example when you quit Vim.
1433 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory
1434 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap
1435 file).
1436 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a
1437 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd|
1438 command.
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +01001439 both: When using ":e bufname" and already editing "bufname"
1440 the buffer is made empty and autocommands are
1441 triggered as usual for |:edit|.
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001442 *E676*
1443 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like
1444 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and
1445 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned
1446 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|,
1447 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001448
1449 *'casemap'* *'cmp'*
1450'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii")
1451 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001452 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain
1453 these words, separated by a comma:
1454 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current
1455 locale does not change the case mapping. This only
Bram Moolenaar6f16eb82005-08-23 21:02:42 +00001456 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding,
1457 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is
1458 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library
1459 functions are used when available.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001460 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US
1461 case mapping, the current locale is not effective.
1462 This probably only matters for Turkish.
1463
1464 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346*
1465'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,")
1466 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001467 {not available when compiled without the
1468 |+file_in_path| feature}
1469 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
Bram Moolenaar00aa0692019-04-27 20:37:57 +02001470 |:cd|, |:tcd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being
1471 searched for has a relative path, not an absolute part starting with
1472 "/", "./" or "../", the 'cdpath' option is not used then.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001473 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as
1474 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|.
1475 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look
1476 in the current directory first.
1477 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include
1478 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to
1479 override it: >
1480 :let &cdpath = ',' . substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g')
1481< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1482 security reasons.
1483 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names).
1484
1485 *'cedit'*
1486'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F)
1487 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001488 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window.
1489 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off.
1490 Only non-printable keys are allowed.
1491 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to
1492 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: >
Bram Moolenaare18dbe82016-07-02 21:42:23 +02001493 :exe "set cedit=\<C-Y>"
1494 :exe "set cedit=\<Esc>"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001495< |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character.
1496 See |cmdwin|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001497 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
1498 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001499
1500 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513*
1501'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "")
1502 global
Bram Moolenaar4c92e752019-02-17 21:18:32 +01001503 {only available when compiled with the |+eval| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001504 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is
1505 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a
1506 different encoding from what is desired.
1507 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is
1508 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is
1509 preferred, because it is much faster.
1510 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no
1511 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first.
1512 The expression must return zero or an empty string for success,
1513 non-zero for failure.
1514 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'.
1515 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are
1516 used.
1517 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8"
1518 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this.
1519 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c'
1520 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion.
1521 Example: >
1522 set charconvert=CharConvert()
1523 fun CharConvert()
1524 system("recode "
1525 \ . v:charconvert_from . ".." . v:charconvert_to
1526 \ . " <" . v:fname_in . " >" v:fname_out)
1527 return v:shell_error
1528 endfun
1529< The related Vim variables are:
1530 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding
1531 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding
1532 v:fname_in name of the input file
1533 v:fname_out name of the output file
1534 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same.
1535 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different
1536 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4.
1537 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want
1538 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care
1539 of this.
1540 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1541 security reasons.
1542
1543 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'*
1544'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off)
1545 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001546 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1547 feature}
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001548 Enables automatic C program indenting. See 'cinkeys' to set the keys
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001549 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your
1550 preferred indent style.
1551 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'.
1552 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty,
1553 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an
1554 external program.
1555 See |C-indenting|.
1556 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent'
1557 option or 'indentexpr'.
1558 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
1559 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
1560
1561 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'*
Bram Moolenaarce655742019-01-31 14:12:57 +01001562'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),0],:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001563 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001564 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1565 feature}
1566 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
1567 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is
1568 empty.
1569 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|.
1570 See |C-indenting|.
1571
1572 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'*
1573'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "")
1574 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001575 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1576 feature}
1577 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C
1578 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and
1579 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general.
1580
1581
1582 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'*
1583'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch")
1584 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001585 {not available when compiled without both the
1586 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features}
1587 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when
1588 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at
1589 an appropriate place (inside {}).
1590 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't
1591 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase:
1592 "if,If,IF".
1593
1594 *'clipboard'* *'cb'*
1595'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux"
1596 for X-windows, "" otherwise)
1597 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001598 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard|
1599 feature is included}
1600 This option is a list of comma separated names.
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01001601 Note: if one of the items is "exclude:", then you can't add an item
1602 after that. Therefore do append an item with += but use ^= to
1603 prepend, e.g.: >
1604 set clipboard^=unnamed
1605< These names are recognized:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001606
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001607 *clipboard-unnamed*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001608 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*'
1609 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which
1610 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a
1611 register is explicitly specified, it will always be
1612 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard'
1613 or not. The clipboard register can always be
1614 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see
1615 |gui-clipboard|.
1616
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001617 *clipboard-unnamedplus*
Bram Moolenaar00154502013-02-13 16:15:55 +01001618 unnamedplus A variant of the "unnamed" flag which uses the
1619 clipboard register '+' (|quoteplus|) instead of
1620 register '*' for all yank, delete, change and put
1621 operations which would normally go to the unnamed
1622 register. When "unnamed" is also included to the
1623 option, yank operations (but not delete, change or
1624 put) will additionally copy the text into register
1625 '*'.
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01001626 Only available with the |+X11| feature.
Bram Moolenaarbf9680e2010-12-02 21:43:16 +01001627 Availability can be checked with: >
1628 if has('unnamedplus')
1629<
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001630 *clipboard-autoselect*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001631 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present,
1632 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual
1633 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the
1634 windowing system's global selection or put the
1635 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection
Bram Moolenaarba3ff532018-11-04 14:45:49 +01001636 register "*. See |'go-a'| and |quotestar| for details.
1637 When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in 'guioptions'
1638 is used, when the GUI is not active, this "autoselect"
1639 flag is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001640 Also applies to the modeless selection.
1641
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001642 *clipboard-autoselectplus*
1643 autoselectplus Like "autoselect" but using the + register instead of
1644 the * register. Compare to the 'P' flag in
1645 'guioptions'.
1646
1647 *clipboard-autoselectml*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001648 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection
1649 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'.
1650
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001651 *clipboard-html*
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001652 html When the clipboard contains HTML, use this when
1653 pasting. When putting text on the clipboard, mark it
1654 as HTML. This works to copy rendered HTML from
1655 Firefox, paste it as raw HTML in Vim, select the HTML
1656 in Vim and paste it in a rich edit box in Firefox.
Bram Moolenaar20a825a2010-05-31 21:27:30 +02001657 You probably want to add this only temporarily,
1658 possibly use BufEnter autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001659 Only supported for GTK version 2 and later.
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001660
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001661 *clipboard-exclude*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001662 exclude:{pattern}
1663 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of
1664 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no
1665 connection will be made to the X server. This is
1666 useful in this situation:
1667 - Running Vim in a console.
1668 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another
1669 display.
1670 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the
1671 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator.
1672 To never connect to the X server use: >
1673 exclude:.*
1674< This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument.
1675 Note that when there is no connection to the X server
1676 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard
1677 cannot be accessed.
1678 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is
1679 interpreted as if 'magic' was on.
1680 The rest of the option value will be used for
1681 {pattern}, this must be the last entry.
1682
1683 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'*
1684'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1)
1685 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001686 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding
1687 |hit-enter| prompts.
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001688 The value of this option is stored with the tab page, so that each tab
1689 page can have a different value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001690
1691 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'*
1692'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7)
1693 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001694 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin|
1695
Bram Moolenaar483c5d82010-10-20 18:45:33 +02001696 *'colorcolumn'* *'cc'*
1697'colorcolumn' 'cc' string (default "")
1698 local to window
Bram Moolenaar483c5d82010-10-20 18:45:33 +02001699 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
1700 feature}
1701 'colorcolumn' is a comma separated list of screen columns that are
1702 highlighted with ColorColumn |hl-ColorColumn|. Useful to align
1703 text. Will make screen redrawing slower.
1704 The screen column can be an absolute number, or a number preceded with
1705 '+' or '-', which is added to or subtracted from 'textwidth'. >
1706
1707 :set cc=+1 " highlight column after 'textwidth'
1708 :set cc=+1,+2,+3 " highlight three columns after 'textwidth'
1709 :hi ColorColumn ctermbg=lightgrey guibg=lightgrey
1710<
1711 When 'textwidth' is zero then the items with '-' and '+' are not used.
1712 A maximum of 256 columns are highlighted.
1713
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001714 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594*
1715'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width)
1716 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001717 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00001718 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see
1719 |posix-screen-size|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001720 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
1721 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
1722 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
1723 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001724 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up. For
1725 the GUI it is always possible and Vim limits the number of columns to
1726 what fits on the screen. You can use this command to get the widest
1727 window possible: >
1728 :set columns=9999
1729< Minimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001730
1731 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525*
1732'comments' 'com' string (default
1733 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-")
1734 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001735 A comma separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See
1736 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to
1737 insert a space.
1738
1739 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537*
1740'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/")
1741 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001742 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
1743 feature}
1744 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the
1745 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see
1746 |fold-marker|.
1747
1748 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'*
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001749'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc|
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02001750 file is found, reset in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001751 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001752 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or
1753 make Vim behave in a more useful way.
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001754
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001755 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset,
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001756 other options are also changed as a side effect.
1757 NOTE: Setting or resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected
1758 effects: Mappings are interpreted in another way, undo behaves
1759 differently, etc. If you set this option in your vimrc file, you
1760 should probably put it at the very start.
1761
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001762 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the
1763 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim
1764 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible'
1765 option.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001766 When a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file is found while Vim is starting up,
Bram Moolenaard042c562005-06-30 22:04:15 +00001767 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been
1768 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001769 that when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file exists, Vim will use the Vim
Bram Moolenaard042c562005-06-30 22:04:15 +00001770 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001771 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file, nor for a file given
1772 with the |-u| argument). Also see |compatible-default| and
1773 |posix-compliance|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001774 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with
1775 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|.
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001776 See 'cpoptions' for more fine tuning of Vi compatibility.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001777
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001778 When this option is set, numerous other options are set to make Vim as
1779 Vi-compatible as possible. When this option is unset, various options
1780 are set to make Vim more useful. The table below lists all the
1781 options affected.
1782 The {?} column indicates when the options are affected:
1783 + Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when
1784 'compatible' is set.
1785 & Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when
1786 'compatible' is set AND is set to its Vim default value when
1787 'compatible' is unset.
1788 - Means the option is NOT changed when setting 'compatible' but IS
1789 set to its Vim default when 'compatible' is unset.
1790 The {effect} column summarises the change when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001791
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001792 option ? set value effect ~
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001793
1794 'allowrevins' + off no CTRL-_ command
1795 'antialias' + off don't use antialiased fonts
1796 'arabic' + off reset arabic-related options
1797 'arabicshape' + on correct character shapes
1798 'backspace' + "" normal backspace
1799 'backup' + off no backup file
1800 'backupcopy' & Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy
1801 else: "auto" copy or rename backup file
1802 'balloonexpr' + "" text to show in evaluation balloon
1803 'breakindent' + off don't indent when wrapping lines
1804 'cedit' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
1805 'cindent' + off no C code indentation
1806 'compatible' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
1807 'copyindent' + off don't copy indent structure
1808 'cpoptions' & (all flags) Vi-compatible flags
1809 'cscopepathcomp'+ 0 don't show directories in tags list
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01001810 'cscoperelative'+ off don't use basename of path as prefix
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001811 'cscopetag' + off don't use cscope for ":tag"
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001812 'cscopetagorder'+ 0 see |cscopetagorder|
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001813 'cscopeverbose' + off see |cscopeverbose|
1814 'delcombine' + off unicode: delete whole char combination
1815 'digraph' + off no digraphs
1816 'esckeys' & off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode
1817 'expandtab' + off tabs not expanded to spaces
1818 'fileformats' & "" no automatic file format detection,
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01001819 "dos,unix" except for MS-Windows
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001820 'formatexpr' + "" use 'formatprg' for auto-formatting
1821 'formatoptions' & "vt" Vi compatible formatting
1822 'gdefault' + off no default 'g' flag for ":s"
1823 'history' & 0 no commandline history
1824 'hkmap' + off no Hebrew keyboard mapping
1825 'hkmapp' + off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping
1826 'hlsearch' + off no highlighting of search matches
1827 'incsearch' + off no incremental searching
1828 'indentexpr' + "" no indenting by expression
1829 'insertmode' + off do not start in Insert mode
1830 'iskeyword' & "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001831 characters and '_'
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001832 'joinspaces' + on insert 2 spaces after period
1833 'modeline' & off no modelines
1834 'more' & off no pauses in listings
1835 'mzquantum' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
1836 'numberwidth' & 8 min number of columns for line number
1837 'preserveindent'+ off don't preserve current indent structure
1838 when changing it
1839 'revins' + off no reverse insert
1840 'ruler' + off no ruler
1841 'scrolljump' + 1 no jump scroll
1842 'scrolloff' + 0 no scroll offset
1843 'shelltemp' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
1844 'shiftround' + off indent not rounded to shiftwidth
Bram Moolenaar9dfa3132019-05-04 21:08:40 +02001845 'shortmess' & "S" no shortening of messages
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001846 'showcmd' & off command characters not shown
1847 'showmode' & off current mode not shown
1848 'sidescrolloff' + 0 cursor moves to edge of screen in scroll
1849 'smartcase' + off no automatic ignore case switch
1850 'smartindent' + off no smart indentation
1851 'smarttab' + off no smart tab size
1852 'softtabstop' + 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions
1853 'startofline' + on goto startofline with some commands
1854 'tagcase' & "followic" 'ignorecase' when searching tags file
1855 'tagrelative' & off tag file names are not relative
1856 'termguicolors' + off don't use highlight-(guifg|guibg)
1857 'textauto' & off no automatic textmode detection
1858 'textwidth' + 0 no automatic line wrap
1859 'tildeop' + off tilde is not an operator
1860 'ttimeout' + off no terminal timeout
1861 'undofile' + off don't use an undo file
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001862 'viminfo' - {unchanged} {set Vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001863 'virtualedit' + "" cursor can only be placed on characters
1864 'whichwrap' & "" left-right movements don't wrap
1865 'wildchar' & CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001866 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001867 'writebackup' + on or off depends on the |+writebackup| feature
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001868
1869 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535*
1870'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i")
1871 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001872 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works
1873 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line
1874 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion
1875 and the places to scan. It is a comma separated list of flags:
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01001876 . scan the current buffer ('wrapscan' is ignored)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001877 w scan buffers from other windows
1878 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list
1879 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list
1880 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list
1881 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00001882 kspell use the currently active spell checking |spell|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001883 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given,
1884 patterns are valid too. For example: >
1885 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish
1886< s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option
1887 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns
1888 are valid too.
1889 i scan current and included files
1890 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro
1891 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D|
1892 ] tag completion
1893 t same as "]"
1894
1895 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are
1896 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files
1897 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for
1898 whole-line completion.
1899
1900 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan:
1901 1. the current buffer
1902 2. buffers in other windows
1903 3. other loaded buffers
1904 4. unloaded buffers
1905 5. tags
1906 6. included files
1907
1908 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'-
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00001909 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns
1910 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001911
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00001912 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'*
1913'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty)
1914 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02001915 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
Bram Moolenaare2c453d2019-08-21 14:37:09 +02001916 feature}
Bram Moolenaarc7486e02005-12-29 22:48:26 +00001917 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion
1918 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001919 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
1920 invoked and what it should return.
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01001921 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1922 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00001923
Bram Moolenaarac3150d2019-07-28 16:36:39 +02001924 *'completeslash'* *'csl'*
1925'completeslash' 'csl' string (default: "")
1926 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar2e693a82019-10-16 22:35:02 +02001927 {only for MS-Windows}
Bram Moolenaarac3150d2019-07-28 16:36:39 +02001928 When this option is set it overrules 'shellslash' for completion:
1929 - When this option is set to "slash", a forward slash is used for path
1930 completion in insert mode. This is useful when editing HTML tag, or
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01001931 Makefile with 'noshellslash' on MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaarac3150d2019-07-28 16:36:39 +02001932 - When this option is set to "backslash", backslash is used. This is
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01001933 useful when editing a batch file with 'shellslash' set on MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaarac3150d2019-07-28 16:36:39 +02001934 - When this option is empty, same character is used as for
1935 'shellslash'.
1936 For Insert mode completion the buffer-local value is used. For
1937 command line completion the global value is used.
1938
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001939 *'completeopt'* *'cot'*
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00001940'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu,preview")
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001941 global
Bram Moolenaarc7453f52006-02-10 23:20:28 +00001942 A comma separated list of options for Insert mode completion
1943 |ins-completion|. The supported values are:
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001944
1945 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The
1946 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and
1947 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu|
1948
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00001949 menuone Use the popup menu also when there is only one match.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00001950 Useful when there is additional information about the
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00001951 match, e.g., what file it comes from.
1952
Bram Moolenaarc1e37902006-04-18 21:55:01 +00001953 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. If
1954 the menu is displayed you can use CTRL-L to add more
1955 characters. Whether case is ignored depends on the kind
1956 of completion. For buffer text the 'ignorecase' option is
1957 used.
Bram Moolenaarc7453f52006-02-10 23:20:28 +00001958
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00001959 preview Show extra information about the currently selected
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001960 completion in the preview window. Only works in
1961 combination with "menu" or "menuone".
1962
Bram Moolenaar576a4a62019-08-18 15:25:17 +02001963 popup Show extra information about the currently selected
1964 completion in a popup window. Only works in combination
1965 with "menu" or "menuone". Overrides "preview".
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02001966 See |'completepopup'| for specifying properties.
Bram Moolenaar2e693a82019-10-16 22:35:02 +02001967 {only works when compiled with the |+textprop| feature}
Bram Moolenaar576a4a62019-08-18 15:25:17 +02001968
Bram Moolenaardca7abe2019-10-20 18:17:57 +02001969 popuphidden
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01001970 Just like "popup" but initially hide the popup. Use a
Bram Moolenaardca7abe2019-10-20 18:17:57 +02001971 |CompleteChanged| autocommand to fetch the info and call
1972 |popup_show()| once the popup has been filled.
1973 See the example at |complete-popuphidden|.
1974 {only works when compiled with the |+textprop| feature}
1975
Bram Moolenaarb6be1e22015-07-10 18:18:40 +02001976 noinsert Do not insert any text for a match until the user selects
1977 a match from the menu. Only works in combination with
1978 "menu" or "menuone". No effect if "longest" is present.
1979
1980 noselect Do not select a match in the menu, force the user to
1981 select one from the menu. Only works in combination with
1982 "menu" or "menuone".
1983
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00001984
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02001985 *'completepopup'* *'cpp'*
1986'completepopup' 'cpp' string (default empty)
1987 global
1988 {not available when compiled without the |+textprop|
1989 or |+quickfix| feature}
1990 When 'completeopt' contains "popup" then this option is used for the
Bram Moolenaar447bfba2020-07-18 16:07:16 +02001991 properties of the info popup when it is created. If an info popup
1992 window already exists it is closed, so that the option value is
1993 applied when it is created again.
1994 You can also use |popup_findinfo()| and then set properties for an
1995 existing info popup with |popup_setoptions()|. See |complete-popup|.
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02001996
1997
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02001998 *'concealcursor'* *'cocu'*
1999'concealcursor' 'cocu' string (default: "")
2000 local to window
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002001 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
2002 feature}
2003 Sets the modes in which text in the cursor line can also be concealed.
2004 When the current mode is listed then concealing happens just like in
2005 other lines.
2006 n Normal mode
2007 v Visual mode
2008 i Insert mode
Bram Moolenaarca8c9862010-07-24 15:00:38 +02002009 c Command line editing, for 'incsearch'
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002010
Bram Moolenaare6dc5732010-07-24 23:52:26 +02002011 'v' applies to all lines in the Visual area, not only the cursor.
Bram Moolenaarca8c9862010-07-24 15:00:38 +02002012 A useful value is "nc". This is used in help files. So long as you
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002013 are moving around text is concealed, but when starting to insert text
2014 or selecting a Visual area the concealed text is displayed, so that
2015 you can see what you are doing.
Bram Moolenaarf70e3d62010-07-24 13:15:07 +02002016 Keep in mind that the cursor position is not always where it's
2017 displayed. E.g., when moving vertically it may change column.
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002018
2019
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02002020 *'conceallevel'* *'cole'*
2021'conceallevel' 'cole' number (default 0)
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002022 local to window
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002023 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
2024 feature}
Bram Moolenaar6df6f472010-07-18 18:04:50 +02002025 Determine how text with the "conceal" syntax attribute |:syn-conceal|
2026 is shown:
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002027
Bram Moolenaar6df6f472010-07-18 18:04:50 +02002028 Value Effect ~
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002029 0 Text is shown normally
Bram Moolenaar477db062010-07-28 18:17:41 +02002030 1 Each block of concealed text is replaced with one
2031 character. If the syntax item does not have a custom
2032 replacement character defined (see |:syn-cchar|) the
2033 character defined in 'listchars' is used (default is a
2034 space).
2035 It is highlighted with the "Conceal" highlight group.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002036 2 Concealed text is completely hidden unless it has a
2037 custom replacement character defined (see
Bram Moolenaar477db062010-07-28 18:17:41 +02002038 |:syn-cchar|).
Bram Moolenaara7781e02010-07-19 20:13:22 +02002039 3 Concealed text is completely hidden.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002040
Bram Moolenaara7781e02010-07-19 20:13:22 +02002041 Note: in the cursor line concealed text is not hidden, so that you can
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002042 edit and copy the text. This can be changed with the 'concealcursor'
2043 option.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002044
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002045 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'*
2046'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off)
2047 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002048 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally
2049 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e",
2050 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current
2051 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer.
2052 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one
2053 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm|
2054 command.
2055 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'.
2056
2057 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'*
2058'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off)
2059 global
Bram Moolenaarf3913272016-02-25 00:00:01 +01002060 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002061
2062 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'*
2063'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off)
2064 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002065 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a
2066 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of
2067 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled,
2068 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the
2069 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00002070 existing line. 'expandtab' has no effect on these characters, a Tab
2071 remains a Tab. If the new indent is greater than on the existing
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002072 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002073 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002074 Also see 'preserveindent'.
2075
Bram Moolenaare0fa3742016-02-20 15:47:01 +01002076 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'* *cpo*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002077'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs",
2078 Vi default: all flags)
2079 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002080 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present
Bram Moolenaar7cba6c02013-09-05 22:13:31 +02002081 this indicates Vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where
2082 not being Vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002083 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options".
2084 Commas can be added for readability.
2085 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
2086 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
2087 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
2088 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002089 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when
2090 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002091 variable exists |posix|. This means Vim tries to behave like the
2092 POSIX specification.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002093
2094 contains behavior ~
2095 *cpo-a*
2096 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name
2097 argument will set the alternate file name for the
2098 current window.
2099 *cpo-A*
2100 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name
2101 argument will set the alternate file name for the
2102 current window.
2103 *cpo-b*
2104 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of
2105 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping,
2106 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next
2107 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to
2108 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all
2109 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands.
2110 See also |map_bar|.
2111 *cpo-B*
2112 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings,
Bram Moolenaara9604e62018-07-21 05:56:22 +02002113 abbreviations, user commands and the "to" part of the
2114 menu commands. Remove this flag to be able to use a
2115 backslash like a CTRL-V. For example, the command
2116 ":map X \<Esc>" results in X being mapped to:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002117 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>)
2118 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters)
2119 ('<' excluded in both cases)
2120 *cpo-c*
2121 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the
2122 cursor position, but not further than the start of the
2123 next line. When not present searching continues
2124 one character from the cursor position. With 'c'
2125 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating
2126 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches.
2127 *cpo-C*
2128 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a
2129 backslash. See |line-continuation|.
2130 *cpo-d*
2131 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use
2132 the tags file relative to the current file, but the
2133 tags file in the current directory.
2134 *cpo-D*
2135 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode
2136 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and
2137 |t|.
2138 *cpo-e*
2139 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a
2140 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not
2141 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register
2142 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a
2143 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line
2144 and can be edited before hitting <CR>.
2145 *cpo-E*
2146 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or
2147 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when
Bram Moolenaar15142e22018-04-30 22:19:58 +02002148 at least one character is to be operated on. Example:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002149 This makes "y0" fail in the first column.
2150 *cpo-f*
2151 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name
2152 argument will set the file name for the current buffer,
2153 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet.
2154 *cpo-F*
2155 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name
2156 argument will set the file name for the current
2157 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00002158 yet. Also see |cpo-P|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002159 *cpo-g*
2160 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002161 *cpo-H*
2162 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert
2163 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after
2164 the last blank.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002165 *cpo-i*
2166 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will
2167 leave it modified.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002168 *cpo-I*
2169 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting
2170 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002171 *cpo-j*
2172 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.',
2173 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'.
2174 *cpo-J*
2175 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00002176 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002177 white space.
2178 *cpo-k*
2179 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in
2180 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu
2181 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[
2182 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X
2183 being mapped to:
2184 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters)
2185 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code)
2186 Also see the '<' flag below.
2187 *cpo-K*
2188 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is
2189 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when
2190 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It
2191 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>.
2192 *cpo-l*
2193 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002194 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special.
2195 See |/[]|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002196 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't'
2197 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab>
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002198 Also see |cpo-\|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002199 *cpo-L*
2200 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin',
2201 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode
2202 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of
2203 the normal behavior of a <Tab>.
2204 *cpo-m*
2205 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a
2206 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half
2207 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'|
2208 *cpo-M*
2209 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into
2210 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer
2211 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores
2212 backslashes, which is Vi compatible.
2213 *cpo-n*
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02002214 n When included, the column used for 'number' and
2215 'relativenumber' will also be used for text of wrapped
2216 lines.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002217 *cpo-o*
2218 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for
2219 next search.
2220 *cpo-O*
2221 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even
2222 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a
2223 protection against a file unexpectedly created by
2224 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this.
2225 *cpo-p*
2226 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a
2227 slightly better algorithm is used.
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00002228 *cpo-P*
2229 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a
2230 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if
2231 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and
2232 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002233 *cpo-q*
2234 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the
2235 position where it would be when joining two lines.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002236 *cpo-r*
2237 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search
2238 command, instead of the actually used search string.
2239 *cpo-R*
2240 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag
2241 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used.
2242 *cpo-s*
2243 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the
2244 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002245 And it is the default. If not present the options are
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002246 set when the buffer is created.
2247 *cpo-S*
2248 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer
2249 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and
2250 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting.
2251 The options are set to the values in the current
2252 buffer. When you change an option and go to another
2253 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the
2254 buffer options global to all buffers.
2255
2256 's' 'S' copy buffer options
2257 no no when buffer created
2258 yes no when buffer first entered (default)
2259 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.)
2260 *cpo-t*
2261 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for
2262 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in
2263 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the
2264 last used search pattern.
2265 *cpo-u*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002266 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002267 *cpo-v*
2268 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in
2269 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are
2270 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the
2271 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced
2272 characters.
2273 *cpo-w*
2274 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one
2275 character and not all blanks until the start of the
2276 next word.
2277 *cpo-W*
2278 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!"
2279 overwrites a readonly file, if possible.
2280 *cpo-x*
2281 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line.
2282 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line,
2283 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>|
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002284 *cpo-X*
2285 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is
2286 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "."
2287 and a count.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002288 *cpo-y*
Bram Moolenaard09091d2019-01-17 16:07:22 +01002289 y A yank command can be redone with ".". Think twice if
2290 you really want to use this, it may break some
2291 plugins, since most people expect "." to only repeat a
2292 change.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002293 *cpo-Z*
2294 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set,
2295 don't reset 'readonly'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002296 *cpo-!*
2297 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used
2298 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last
2299 used -filter- command is used.
2300 *cpo-$*
2301 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the
2302 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text.
2303 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the
2304 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any
2305 command that moves the cursor from the insertion
2306 point.
2307 *cpo-%*
2308 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command.
2309 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc.
2310 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/".
2311 Parens inside single and double quotes are also
2312 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to
2313 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like
2314 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not
2315 match the last one. When this flag is not included,
2316 parens inside single and double quotes are treated
2317 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes,
2318 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a
2319 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002320 there is one). This works very well for C programs.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00002321 This flag is also used for other features, such as
2322 C-indenting.
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00002323 *cpo--*
2324 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when
Bram Moolenaar8ada17c2006-01-19 22:16:24 +00002325 it would go above the first line or below the last
2326 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or
2327 last line, unless it already was in that line.
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00002328 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j",
Bram Moolenaar8ada17c2006-01-19 22:16:24 +00002329 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234".
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002330 *cpo-+*
2331 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the
2332 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer
2333 itself may still be different from its file.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002334 *cpo-star*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002335 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included,
2336 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area.
2337 *cpo-<*
2338 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>|
2339 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002340 menu commands. For example, the command
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002341 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to:
2342 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters)
2343 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>)
2344 Also see the 'k' flag above.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002345 *cpo->*
2346 > When appending to a register, put a line break before
2347 the appended text.
Bram Moolenaar8b3e0332011-06-26 05:36:34 +02002348 *cpo-;*
2349 ; When using |,| or |;| to repeat the last |t| search
2350 and the cursor is right in front of the searched
2351 character, the cursor won't move. When not included,
2352 the cursor would skip over it and jump to the
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +02002353 following occurrence.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002354
2355 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except
2356 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix|
2357
2358 contains behavior ~
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002359 *cpo-#*
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002360 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002361 *cpo-&*
2362 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when
2363 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded.
2364 This flag is tested when exiting.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002365 *cpo-\*
2366 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
2367 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]|
Bram Moolenaar90915b52005-08-21 22:17:52 +00002368 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-'
2369 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-'
2370 Also see |cpo-l|.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002371 *cpo-/*
2372 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s|
2373 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%|
2374 *cpo-{*
2375 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character
2376 at the start of a line.
2377 *cpo-.*
2378 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current
2379 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't
2380 need this, since it remembers the full path of an
2381 opened file.
2382 *cpo-bar*
2383 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment
2384 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained
2385 with system specific functions.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002386
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002387
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002388 *'cryptmethod'* *'cm'*
Bram Moolenaara86187b2018-12-16 18:20:00 +01002389'cryptmethod' 'cm' string (default "blowfish2")
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002390 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002391 Method used for encryption when the buffer is written to a file:
Bram Moolenaar0bbabe82010-05-17 20:32:55 +02002392 *pkzip*
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002393 zip PkZip compatible method. A weak kind of encryption.
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002394 Backwards compatible with Vim 7.2 and older.
Bram Moolenaar0bbabe82010-05-17 20:32:55 +02002395 *blowfish*
Bram Moolenaar8f4ac012014-08-10 13:38:34 +02002396 blowfish Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption but it has
2397 an implementation flaw. Requires Vim 7.3 or later,
2398 files can NOT be read by Vim 7.2 and older. This adds
2399 a "seed" to the file, every time you write the file
2400 the encrypted bytes will be different.
2401 *blowfish2*
2402 blowfish2 Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption. Requires
Bram Moolenaar5e9b2fa2016-02-01 22:37:05 +01002403 Vim 7.4.401 or later, files can NOT be read by Vim 7.3
Bram Moolenaar8f4ac012014-08-10 13:38:34 +02002404 and older. This adds a "seed" to the file, every time
2405 you write the file the encrypted bytes will be
2406 different. The whole undo file is encrypted, not just
2407 the pieces of text.
Christian Brabandtf573c6e2021-06-20 14:02:16 +02002408 *E1193* *E1194* *E1195* *E1196*
2409 *E1197* *E1198* *E1199* *E1200* *E1201*
2410 xchacha20 XChaCha20 Cipher with Poly1305 Message Authentication
2411 Code. Medium strong till strong encryption.
2412 Encryption is provided by the libsodium library, it
Bram Moolenaar22863042021-10-16 15:23:36 +01002413 requires Vim to be built with |+sodium|.
Christian Brabandtf573c6e2021-06-20 14:02:16 +02002414 It adds a seed and a message authentication code (MAC)
2415 to the file. This needs at least a Vim 8.2.3022 to
2416 read the encrypted file.
2417 Encryption of swap files is not supported, therefore
2418 no swap file will be used when xchacha20 encryption is
2419 enabled.
2420 Encryption of undo files is not yet supported,
2421 therefore no undo file will currently be written.
2422 CURRENTLY EXPERIMENTAL: Files written with this method
2423 might have to be read back with the same version of
2424 Vim if the binary format changes later.
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002425
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01002426 You should use "blowfish2", also to re-encrypt older files.
2427
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002428 When reading an encrypted file 'cryptmethod' will be set automatically
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002429 to the detected method of the file being read. Thus if you write it
2430 without changing 'cryptmethod' the same method will be used.
2431 Changing 'cryptmethod' does not mark the file as modified, you have to
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002432 explicitly write it, you don't get a warning unless there are other
2433 modifications. Also see |:X|.
2434
2435 When setting the global value to an empty string, it will end up with
Bram Moolenaara86187b2018-12-16 18:20:00 +01002436 the value "blowfish2". When setting the local value to an empty
2437 string the buffer will use the global value.
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002438
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002439 When a new encryption method is added in a later version of Vim, and
2440 the current version does not recognize it, you will get *E821* .
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002441 You need to edit this file with the later version of Vim.
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002442
2443
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002444 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'*
2445'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0)
2446 global
2447 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2448 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002449 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags.
2450 See |cscopepathcomp|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002451 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002452
2453 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'*
2454'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope")
2455 global
2456 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2457 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002458 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|.
2459 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2460 security reasons.
2461
2462 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'*
2463'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "")
2464 global
2465 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2466 or |+quickfix| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002467 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results.
2468 See |cscopequickfix|.
2469
Bram Moolenaarec7944a2013-06-12 21:29:15 +02002470 *'cscoperelative'* *'csre'* *'nocscoperelative'* *'nocsre'*
Bram Moolenaar2f982e42011-06-12 20:42:22 +02002471'cscoperelative' 'csre' boolean (default off)
2472 global
2473 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2474 feature}
Bram Moolenaar2f982e42011-06-12 20:42:22 +02002475 In the absence of a prefix (-P) for cscope. setting this option enables
2476 to use the basename of cscope.out path as the prefix.
2477 See |cscoperelative|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002478 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar2f982e42011-06-12 20:42:22 +02002479
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002480 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'*
2481'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off)
2482 global
2483 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2484 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002485 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|.
2486 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2487
2488 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'*
2489'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0)
2490 global
2491 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2492 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002493 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See
2494 |cscopetagorder|.
2495 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
2496
2497 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'*
2498 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'*
2499'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off)
2500 global
2501 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2502 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002503 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|.
2504 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2505
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002506 *'cursorbind'* *'crb'* *'nocursorbind'* *'nocrb'*
2507'cursorbind' 'crb' boolean (default off)
2508 local to window
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002509 When this option is set, as the cursor in the current
2510 window moves other cursorbound windows (windows that also have
2511 this option set) move their cursors to the corresponding line and
2512 column. This option is useful for viewing the
2513 differences between two versions of a file (see 'diff'); in diff mode,
2514 inserted and deleted lines (though not characters within a line) are
Bram Moolenaar1a384422010-07-14 19:53:30 +02002515 taken into account.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002516
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002517
2518 *'cursorcolumn'* *'cuc'* *'nocursorcolumn'* *'nocuc'*
2519'cursorcolumn' 'cuc' boolean (default off)
2520 local to window
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02002521 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002522 feature}
2523 Highlight the screen column of the cursor with CursorColumn
2524 |hl-CursorColumn|. Useful to align text. Will make screen redrawing
2525 slower.
Bram Moolenaar4c3f5362006-04-11 21:38:50 +00002526 If you only want the highlighting in the current window you can use
2527 these autocommands: >
2528 au WinLeave * set nocursorline nocursorcolumn
2529 au WinEnter * set cursorline cursorcolumn
2530<
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002531
2532 *'cursorline'* *'cul'* *'nocursorline'* *'nocul'*
2533'cursorline' 'cul' boolean (default off)
2534 local to window
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02002535 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002536 feature}
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002537 Highlight the text line of the cursor with CursorLine |hl-CursorLine|.
2538 Useful to easily spot the cursor. Will make screen redrawing slower.
Bram Moolenaare2f98b92006-03-29 21:18:24 +00002539 When Visual mode is active the highlighting isn't used to make it
Bram Moolenaar779b74b2006-04-10 14:55:34 +00002540 easier to see the selected text.
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002541
2542
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002543 *'cursorlineopt'* *'culopt'*
Bram Moolenaar017ba072019-09-14 21:01:23 +02002544'cursorlineopt' 'culopt' string (default: "number,line")
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002545 local to window
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002546 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
2547 feature}
Bram Moolenaar017ba072019-09-14 21:01:23 +02002548 Comma separated list of settings for how 'cursorline' is displayed.
2549 Valid values:
2550 "line" Highlight the text line of the cursor with
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002551 CursorLine |hl-CursorLine|.
Bram Moolenaar017ba072019-09-14 21:01:23 +02002552 "screenline" Highlight only the screen line of the cursor with
2553 CursorLine |hl-CursorLine|.
2554 "number" Highlight the line number of the cursor with
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002555 CursorLineNr |hl-CursorLineNr|.
Bram Moolenaar017ba072019-09-14 21:01:23 +02002556
2557 Special value:
2558 "both" Alias for the values "line,number".
2559
2560 "line" and "screenline" cannot be used together.
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002561
2562
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002563 *'debug'*
2564'debug' string (default "")
2565 global
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00002566 These values can be used:
2567 msg Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
2568 anyway.
2569 throw Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
2570 anyway and also throw an exception and set |v:errmsg|.
2571 beep A message will be given when otherwise only a beep would be
2572 produced.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002573 The values can be combined, separated by a comma.
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00002574 "msg" and "throw" are useful for debugging 'foldexpr', 'formatexpr' or
2575 'indentexpr'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002576
2577 *'define'* *'def'*
2578'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define")
2579 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002580 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002581 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the
2582 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is
2583 used to recognize the defined name after the match:
2584 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char}
2585 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space
2586 or backslash.
2587 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be
2588 useful, to include const type declarations: >
2589 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\)
Bram Moolenaar63b74a82019-03-24 15:09:13 +01002590< You can also use "\ze" just before the name and continue the pattern
2591 to check what is following. E.g. for Javascript, if a function is
2592 defined with "func_name = function(args)": >
2593 ^\s*\ze\i\+\s*=\s*function(
2594< If the function is defined with "func_name : function() {...": >
2595 ^\s*\ze\i\+\s*[:]\s*(*function\s*(
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002596< When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes!
Bram Moolenaar63b74a82019-03-24 15:09:13 +01002597 To avoid that use `:let` with a single quote string: >
2598 let &l:define = '^\s*\ze\k\+\s*=\s*function('
Bram Moolenaar911ead12019-04-21 00:03:35 +02002599<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002600
2601 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'*
2602'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off)
2603 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002604 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode
2605 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the
2606 default) the character along with its combining characters are
2607 deleted.
Bram Moolenaar4f4d51a2020-10-11 13:57:40 +02002608 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work differently from "2x"!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002609
2610 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one
2611 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want
2612 to remove only the combining ones.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002613 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002614
2615 *'dictionary'* *'dict'*
2616'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "")
2617 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002618 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
2619 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should
2620 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several
2621 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is
2622 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes.
Bram Moolenaar259f26a2018-05-15 22:25:40 +02002623
2624 When this option is empty or an entry "spell" is present, and spell
2625 checking is enabled, words in the word lists for the currently active
2626 'spelllang' are used. See |spell|.
2627
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002628 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002629 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
2630 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00002631 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002632 Where to find a list of words?
2633 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words".
2634 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory.
2635 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection.
2636 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
2637 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
2638 uses another default.
2639 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
2640
2641 *'diff'* *'nodiff'*
2642'diff' boolean (default off)
2643 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002644 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2645 feature}
2646 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002647 between files. See |vimdiff|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002648
2649 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'*
2650'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "")
2651 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002652 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2653 feature}
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02002654 Expression which is evaluated to obtain a diff file (either ed-style
2655 or unified-style) from two versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002656 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2657 security reasons.
2658
2659 *'dip'* *'diffopt'*
Bram Moolenaarc8234772019-11-10 21:00:27 +01002660'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "internal,filler,closeoff")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002661 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002662 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2663 feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002664 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002665 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma.
2666
2667 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text
2668 synchronized with a window that has inserted
2669 lines at the same position. Mostly useful
2670 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind'
2671 is set.
2672
2673 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change
2674 and a fold that contains unchanged lines.
2675 When omitted a context of six lines is used.
Bram Moolenaarf6b40102019-02-22 15:24:03 +01002676 When using zero the context is actually one,
2677 since folds require a line in between, also
2678 for a deleted line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002679 See |fold-diff|.
2680
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02002681 iblank Ignore changes where lines are all blank. Adds
2682 the "-B" flag to the "diff" command if
2683 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
2684 of the "diff" command for what this does
2685 exactly.
2686 NOTE: the diff windows will get out of sync,
2687 because no differences between blank lines are
2688 taken into account.
2689
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002690 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A"
2691 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag
2692 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty.
2693
2694 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds
2695 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if
2696 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
2697 of the "diff" command for what this does
2698 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing
2699 white space, but not leading white space.
2700
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02002701 iwhiteall Ignore all white space changes. Adds
2702 the "-w" flag to the "diff" command if
2703 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
2704 of the "diff" command for what this does
2705 exactly.
2706
2707 iwhiteeol Ignore white space changes at end of line.
2708 Adds the "-Z" flag to the "diff" command if
2709 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
2710 of the "diff" command for what this does
2711 exactly.
2712
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00002713 horizontal Start diff mode with horizontal splits (unless
2714 explicitly specified otherwise).
2715
2716 vertical Start diff mode with vertical splits (unless
2717 explicitly specified otherwise).
2718
Bram Moolenaarc8234772019-11-10 21:00:27 +01002719 closeoff When a window is closed where 'diff' is set
2720 and there is only one window remaining in the
2721 same tab page with 'diff' set, execute
2722 `:diffoff` in that window. This undoes a
2723 `:diffsplit` command.
2724
Bram Moolenaar97ce4192017-12-01 20:35:58 +01002725 hiddenoff Do not use diff mode for a buffer when it
2726 becomes hidden.
2727
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00002728 foldcolumn:{n} Set the 'foldcolumn' option to {n} when
2729 starting diff mode. Without this 2 is used.
2730
Bram Moolenaar4223d432021-02-10 13:18:17 +01002731 followwrap Follow the 'wrap' option and leave as it is.
2732
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02002733 internal Use the internal diff library. This is
2734 ignored when 'diffexpr' is set. *E960*
2735 When running out of memory when writing a
2736 buffer this item will be ignored for diffs
2737 involving that buffer. Set the 'verbose'
2738 option to see when this happens.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002739
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02002740 indent-heuristic
Bram Moolenaarf0d58ef2018-11-16 16:13:44 +01002741 Use the indent heuristic for the internal
2742 diff library.
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02002743
2744 algorithm:{text} Use the specified diff algorithm with the
Bram Moolenaarf0d58ef2018-11-16 16:13:44 +01002745 internal diff engine. Currently supported
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02002746 algorithms are:
2747 myers the default algorithm
2748 minimal spend extra time to generate the
2749 smallest possible diff
2750 patience patience diff algorithm
2751 histogram histogram diff algorithm
2752
2753 Examples: >
2754 :set diffopt=internal,filler,context:4
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002755 :set diffopt=
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02002756 :set diffopt=internal,filler,foldcolumn:3
2757 :set diffopt-=internal " do NOT use the internal diff parser
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002758<
2759 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'*
2760'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off)
2761 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002762 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs|
2763 feature}
2764 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS>
2765 {char2}. See |digraphs|.
2766 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2767
2768 *'directory'* *'dir'*
2769'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01002770 for Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:\tmp,c:\temp"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002771 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp")
2772 global
2773 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaare7b1ea02020-08-07 19:54:59 +02002774 Recommended value: ".,~/vimswap//" - this will put the swap file next
2775 to the edited file if possible, and in your personal swap directory
2776 otherwise. Make sure "~/vimswap//" is only readable for you.
2777
2778 Possible items:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002779 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is
2780 possible.
2781 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is
Bram Moolenaar00e192b2019-10-19 17:01:28 +02002782 impossible!) and no |E303| error will be given.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002783 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as
2784 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so
2785 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden"
2786 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible.
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01002787 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-Windows) means to put
2788 the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading "."
2789 is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02002790 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//",
2791 the swap file name will be built from the complete path to the file
Bram Moolenaar207f0092020-08-30 17:20:20 +02002792 with all path separators replaced by percent '%' signs (including
2793 the colon following the drive letter on Win32). This will ensure
2794 file name uniqueness in the preserve directory.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02002795 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a
2796 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will
2797 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to
2798 use '//', instead of '\\'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002799 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
2800 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
2801 name, precede it with a backslash.
2802 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
2803 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'.
2804 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
2805 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
2806 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
2807 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
2808< - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
2809 of the option is removed.
2810 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing
2811 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is
2812 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file.
2813 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better
Bram Moolenaare7b1ea02020-08-07 19:54:59 +02002814 choice than "/tmp". But others on the computer may be able to see the
2815 files, and it can contain a lot of files, your swap files get lost in
2816 the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your home directory is
2817 tried first.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002818 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
2819 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
2820 uses another default.
2821 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2822 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002823
2824 *'display'* *'dy'*
Bram Moolenaarbc8801c2016-08-02 21:04:33 +02002825'display' 'dy' string (default "", set to "truncate" in
2826 |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002827 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002828 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma separated list of
2829 flags:
2830 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line
Bram Moolenaarad9c2a02016-07-27 23:26:04 +02002831 in a window will be displayed. "@@@" is put in the
2832 last columns of the last screen line to indicate the
2833 rest of the line is not displayed.
2834 truncate Like "lastline", but "@@@" is displayed in the first
2835 column of the last screen line. Overrules "lastline".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002836 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx>
2837 instead of using ^C and ~C.
2838
Bram Moolenaard0796902016-09-16 20:02:31 +02002839 When neither "lastline" nor "truncate" is included, a last line that
Bram Moolenaarad9c2a02016-07-27 23:26:04 +02002840 doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines.
2841
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002842 *'eadirection'* *'ead'*
2843'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both")
2844 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002845 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies:
2846 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected
2847 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected
2848 both width and height of windows is affected
2849
2850 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'*
2851'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off)
2852 global
2853 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be
2854 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See
2855 also 'gdefault' option.
Bram Moolenaarb4d6c3e2017-05-27 16:45:17 +02002856 Switching this option on may break plugins!
Bram Moolenaar4072ba52020-12-23 13:56:35 +01002857 This option is not used in |Vim9| script.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002858
Bram Moolenaar03413f42016-04-12 21:07:15 +02002859 *'emoji'* *'emo'* *'noemoji'* *'noemo'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01002860'emoji' 'emo' boolean (default: on)
2861 global
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01002862 When on all Unicode emoji characters are considered to be full width.
Bram Moolenaar1d59aa12020-09-19 18:50:13 +02002863 This excludes "text emoji" characters, which are normally displayed as
2864 single width. Unfortunately there is no good specification for this
2865 and it has been determined on trial-and-error basis. Use the
2866 |setcellwidths()| function to change the behavior.
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01002867
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002868 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543*
K.Takataf883d902021-05-30 18:04:19 +02002869'encoding' 'enc' string (default for MS-Windows: "utf-8",
2870 otherwise: value from $LANG or "latin1")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002871 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002872 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in
2873 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the
2874 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work
2875 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values.
2876
2877 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002878 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002879 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00002880 starts up. See |multibyte|. To reload the menus see |:menutrans|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002881
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02002882 This option cannot be set from a |modeline|. It would most likely
2883 corrupt the text.
2884
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01002885 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 or later, it is highly recommended to set 'encoding'
2886 to "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002887 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and
2888 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002889 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002890 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files
2891 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty).
2892
2893 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002894 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002895 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'.
2896
Bram Moolenaar207f0092020-08-30 17:20:20 +02002897 If you need to know whether 'encoding' is a multibyte encoding, you
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002898 can use: >
2899 if has("multi_byte_encoding")
2900<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002901 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will
2902 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If
2903 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be
2904 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|.
2905
2906 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand
2907 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary.
2908
2909 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
2910 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated
2911 to '-' signs.
2912 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name.
2913 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes
2914 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8".
2915
2916 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected.
2917 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the
2918 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and
2919 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using
2920 utf-8.
2921
2922 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8.
2923 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the
2924 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus
2925 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has
2926 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty.
2927
Bram Moolenaar661b1822005-07-28 22:36:45 +00002928 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was
2929 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002930
2931 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'*
2932'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on)
2933 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002934 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02002935 is on, or 'fixeol' option is off, no <EOL> will be written for the
2936 last line in the file. This option is automatically set or reset when
2937 starting to edit a new file, depending on whether file has an <EOL>
2938 for the last line in the file. Normally you don't have to set or
2939 reset this option.
2940 When 'binary' is off and 'fixeol' is on the value is not used when
2941 writing the file. When 'binary' is on or 'fixeol' is off it is used
2942 to remember the presence of a <EOL> for the last line in the file, so
2943 that when you write the file the situation from the original file can
2944 be kept. But you can change it if you want to.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002945
2946 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'*
2947'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on)
2948 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002949 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after
Bram Moolenaar009b2592004-10-24 19:18:58 +00002950 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the
2951 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the
2952 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When
2953 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it
2954 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright').
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002955 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size
2956 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The
2957 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected.
Bram Moolenaar67f71312007-08-12 14:55:56 +00002958 Changing the height and width of a window can be avoided by setting
2959 'winfixheight' and 'winfixwidth', respectively.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002960 If a window size is specified when creating a new window sizes are
2961 currently not equalized (it's complicated, but may be implemented in
2962 the future).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002963
2964 *'equalprg'* *'ep'*
2965'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "")
2966 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002967 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00002968 the internal formatting functions are used; either 'lisp', 'cindent'
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002969 or 'indentexpr'. When Vim was compiled without internal formatting,
2970 the "indent" program is used.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002971 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002972 about including spaces and backslashes.
2973 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2974 security reasons.
2975
2976 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'*
2977'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off)
2978 global
2979 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only
2980 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always
2981 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002982 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep,
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02002983 screen flash or do nothing. See 'belloff' to finetune when to ring the
2984 bell.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002985
2986 *'errorfile'* *'ef'*
2987'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err",
2988 others: "errors.err")
2989 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002990 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
2991 feature}
2992 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|).
2993 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the
2994 following argument. See |-q|.
2995 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that.
2996 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
2997 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
2998 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2999 security reasons.
3000
3001 *'errorformat'* *'efm'*
3002'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long)
3003 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003004 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3005 feature}
3006 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file
3007 (see |errorformat|).
3008
3009 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'*
3010'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3011 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003012 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert
3013 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be
3014 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of
3015 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of
3016 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to
3017 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that
3018 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys
3019 won't work by default.
3020 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3021 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaarc8234772019-11-10 21:00:27 +01003022 NOTE: when this option is off then the |modifyOtherKeys| functionality
3023 is disabled while in Insert mode to avoid ending Insert mode with any
3024 key that has a modifier.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003025
3026 *'eventignore'* *'ei'*
3027'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "")
3028 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003029 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored.
Bram Moolenaarf193fff2006-04-27 00:02:13 +00003030 When set to "all" or when "all" is one of the items, all autocommand
3031 events are ignored, autocommands will not be executed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003032 Otherwise this is a comma separated list of event names. Example: >
3033 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave
3034<
3035 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'*
3036'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off)
3037 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003038 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003039 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003040 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is
3041 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02003042 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and restored when
3043 the 'paste' option is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003044 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3045
3046 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'*
3047'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off)
3048 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003049 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current
Bram Moolenaar36f44c22016-08-28 18:17:20 +02003050 directory.
3051
3052 Setting this option is a potential security leak. E.g., consider
3053 unpacking a package or fetching files from github, a .vimrc in there
3054 might be a trojan horse. BETTER NOT SET THIS OPTION!
3055 Instead, define an autocommand in your .vimrc to set options for a
3056 matching directory.
3057
3058 If you do switch this option on you should also consider setting the
3059 'secure' option (see |initialization|).
3060 Also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003061 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3062 security reasons.
3063
3064 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213*
3065'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "")
3066 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003067 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003068
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003069 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003070 done when writing the file. For reading see below.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003071 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be
3072 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file).
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01003073 No error will be given when the value is set, only when it is used,
3074 only when writing a file.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003075 Conversion will also be done when 'encoding' and 'fileencoding' are
3076 both a Unicode encoding and 'fileencoding' is not utf-8. That's
3077 because internally Unicode is always stored as utf-8.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003078 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003079 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding, conversion
3080 is most likely done in a way that the reverse conversion
3081 results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some
3082 characters may be lost!
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003083
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003084 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be
3085 specified that can be handled by the converter, see
3086 |mbyte-conversion|.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003087
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003088 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'.
3089 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003090 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument. One exception: when
3091 'fileencodings' is empty the value of 'fileencoding' is used.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003092 For a new file the global value of 'fileencoding' is used.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003093
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003094 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored.
3095 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3096 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are
3097 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for
3098 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example
3099 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2".
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003100
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003101 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3102 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003103
3104 Keep in mind that changing 'fenc' from a modeline happens
3105 AFTER the text has been read, thus it applies to when the file will be
3106 written. If you do set 'fenc' in a modeline, you might want to set
3107 'nomodified' to avoid not being able to ":q".
3108
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003109 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3110
3111 *'fe'*
3112 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003113 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003114 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used.
3115
3116 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'*
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00003117'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom",
3118 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when
3119 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003120 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003121 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit
3122 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first
3123 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one
3124 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003125 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003126 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used.
3127 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
3128 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants)
3129 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse
3130 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not
Bram Moolenaarc6d8db72005-12-13 20:04:55 +00003131 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use
3132 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters
3133 that can't be converted.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003134 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings
3135 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except
3136 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer
3137 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your
3138 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: >
3139 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 |
3140 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif
3141< This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain
3142 non-blank characters.
Bram Moolenaarc6d8db72005-12-13 20:04:55 +00003143 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is
3144 not used.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003145 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, the global value
3146 of 'fileencoding' is used instead. You can set it with: >
3147 :setglobal fenc=iso-8859-2
3148< This means that a non-existing file may get a different encoding than
3149 an empty file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003150 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM
3151 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded
3152 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly.
3153 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last,
3154 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always
3155 accepted.
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00003156 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the
K.Takataef8706f2021-05-31 18:40:49 +02003157 environment. On MS-Windows this is the system encoding. Otherwise
3158 this is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful when
3159 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a non-latin1
3160 encoding, such as Russian.
Bram Moolenaarca003e12006-03-17 23:19:38 +00003161 When 'encoding' is "utf-8" and a file contains an illegal byte
3162 sequence it won't be recognized as UTF-8. You can use the |8g8|
3163 command to find the illegal byte sequence.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003164 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG:
3165 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used
3166 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8
3167 file
3168 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used
3169 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified.
3170 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values.
3171 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file
3172 is read.
3173
3174 *'fileformat'* *'ff'*
Bram Moolenaar00590742019-02-15 21:06:09 +01003175'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-Windows default: "dos",
3176 Unix, macOS default: "unix")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003177 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003178 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for
3179 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file:
Bram Moolenaar4072ba52020-12-23 13:56:35 +01003180 dos <CR><NL>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003181 unix <NL>
3182 mac <CR>
3183 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored.
3184 See |file-formats| and |file-read|.
3185 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'.
3186 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O
Bram Moolenaarbf884932013-04-05 22:26:15 +02003187 works like it was set to "unix".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003188 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and
3189 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off.
3190 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3191 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
3192 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3193 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos",
3194 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset.
3195
3196 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'*
3197'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default:
Bram Moolenaar00590742019-02-15 21:06:09 +01003198 Vim+Vi MS-Windows: "dos,unix",
3199 Vim Unix, macOS: "unix,dos",
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003200 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos",
3201 Vi others: "")
3202 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003203 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when
3204 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing
3205 buffer:
3206 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used
3207 always. It is not set automatically.
3208 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003209 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003210 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing
3211 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to.
3212 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic
3213 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to
3214 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>:
3215 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos",
3216 'fileformat' is set to "dos".
3217 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003218 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003219 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos".
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +01003220 3. If 'fileformat' has not yet been set, and if a <CR> is found, and
3221 if 'fileformats' includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
Bram Moolenaar00659062010-09-21 22:34:02 +02003222 This means that "mac" is only chosen when:
3223 "unix" is not present or no <NL> is found in the file, and
3224 "dos" is not present or no <CR><NL> is found in the file.
3225 Except: if "unix" was chosen, but there is a <CR> before
3226 the first <NL>, and there appear to be more <CR>s than <NL>s in
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01003227 the first few lines, "mac" is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003228 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from
3229 'fileformats' is used.
3230 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but
3231 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that
3232 file only, the option is not changed.
3233 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used.
3234
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01003235 When Vim starts up with an empty buffer the first item is used. You
3236 can overrule this by setting 'fileformat' in your .vimrc.
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01003237
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003238 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that
3239 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be
3240 done:
3241 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos
3242 format will be used.
3243 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection
3244 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a
3245 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is
3246 used.
3247 Also see |file-formats|.
3248 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty
3249 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset,
3250 otherwise 'textauto' is set.
3251 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3252 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3253
Bram Moolenaarbf884932013-04-05 22:26:15 +02003254 *'fileignorecase'* *'fic'* *'nofileignorecase'* *'nofic'*
3255'fileignorecase' 'fic' boolean (default on for systems where case in file
3256 names is normally ignored)
Bram Moolenaar71afbfe2013-03-19 16:49:16 +01003257 global
Bram Moolenaar71afbfe2013-03-19 16:49:16 +01003258 When set case is ignored when using file names and directories.
3259 See 'wildignorecase' for only ignoring case when doing completion.
3260
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003261 *'filetype'* *'ft'*
3262'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "")
3263 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003264 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered.
3265 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be
3266 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file
3267 name.
3268 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type.
3269 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable
3270 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype|
3271 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline,
3272 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003273 Example, for in an IDL file:
3274 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */ ~
3275 |FileType| |filetypes|
3276 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
3277 names. Example:
3278 /* vim: set filetype=c.doxygen : */ ~
3279 This will use the "c" filetype first, then the "doxygen" filetype.
3280 This works both for filetype plugins and for syntax files. More than
3281 one dot may appear.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003282 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
3283 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003284 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003285
3286 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'*
Bram Moolenaara98f8a22021-02-13 18:24:23 +01003287'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-,eob:~")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003288 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02003289 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3290 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003291 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators.
3292 It is a comma separated list of items:
3293
3294 item default Used for ~
3295 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window
Bram Moolenaar38a55632016-02-15 22:07:32 +01003296 stlnc:c ' ' or '=' statusline of the non-current windows
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003297 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit|
3298 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext'
Bram Moolenaar3aca5a62021-02-17 13:14:07 +01003299 foldopen:c '-' mark the beginning of a fold
3300 foldclose:c '+' show a closed fold
3301 foldsep:c '|' open fold middle character
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003302 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option
Bram Moolenaara98f8a22021-02-13 18:24:23 +01003303 eob:c '~' empty lines below the end of a buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003304
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003305 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and
Bram Moolenaar38a55632016-02-15 22:07:32 +01003306 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '='
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003307 otherwise.
3308
3309 Example: >
Bram Moolenaar38a55632016-02-15 22:07:32 +01003310 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:=,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:-
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003311< This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also
3312 be used when there is highlighting.
3313
Bram Moolenaar008bff92021-03-04 21:55:58 +01003314 For "stl" and "stlnc" single-byte and multibyte characters are
3315 supported. But double-width characters are not supported.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003316
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003317 The highlighting used for these items:
3318 item highlight group ~
3319 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine|
3320 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC|
3321 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit|
3322 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded|
3323 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete|
Bram Moolenaara98f8a22021-02-13 18:24:23 +01003324 eob:c EndOfBuffer |hl-EndOfBuffer|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003325
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02003326 *'fixendofline'* *'fixeol'* *'nofixendofline'* *'nofixeol'*
3327'fixendofline' 'fixeol' boolean (default on)
3328 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02003329 When writing a file and this option is on, <EOL> at the end of file
3330 will be restored if missing. Turn this option off if you want to
3331 preserve the situation from the original file.
3332 When the 'binary' option is set the value of this option doesn't
3333 matter.
3334 See the 'endofline' option.
3335
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003336 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'*
Bram Moolenaar98a29d02021-01-18 19:55:44 +01003337'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003338 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003339 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3340 feature}
Bram Moolenaar14184a32019-02-16 15:10:30 +01003341 This option was for using Farsi, which has been removed. See
3342 |farsi.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003343
3344 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'*
3345'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "")
3346 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003347 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3348 feature}
3349 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and
3350 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to
3351 automatically close when moving out of them.
3352
3353 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'*
3354'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0)
3355 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003356 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3357 feature}
3358 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side
3359 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum
3360 value is 12.
3361 See |folding|.
3362
3363 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'*
3364'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on)
3365 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003366 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3367 feature}
3368 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly
3369 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with
3370 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003371 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003372 'foldenable' is off.
3373 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold.
3374 See |folding|.
3375
3376 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'*
3377'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0")
3378 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003379 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02003380 or |+eval| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003381 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003382 for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003383
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003384 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
3385 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003386 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003387 on or the 'modelineexpr' option is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003388
3389 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
3390 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003391
3392 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'*
3393'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#")
3394 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003395 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3396 feature}
3397 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with
3398 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003399 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003400 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|.
3401
3402 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'*
3403'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0)
3404 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003405 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3406 feature}
3407 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed.
3408 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will
3409 close fewer folds.
3410 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|.
3411 See |fold-foldlevel|.
3412
3413 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'*
3414'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1)
3415 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003416 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3417 feature}
3418 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window.
3419 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero),
3420 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99).
3421 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003422 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003423 ignores this option and closes all folds.
3424 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to
3425 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files.
3426 When the value is negative, it is not used.
3427
3428 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536*
3429'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}")
3430 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003431 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3432 feature}
3433 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There
3434 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The
3435 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow).
3436 See |fold-marker|.
3437
3438 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'*
3439'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual")
3440 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003441 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3442 feature}
3443 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values:
3444 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually.
3445 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold.
3446 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line.
3447 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds.
3448 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds.
3449 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed.
3450
3451 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'*
3452'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1)
3453 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003454 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3455 feature}
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01003456 Sets the number of screen lines above which a fold can be displayed
3457 closed. Also for manually closed folds. With the default value of
3458 one a fold can only be closed if it takes up two or more screen lines.
3459 Set to zero to be able to close folds of just one screen line.
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +02003460 Note that this only has an effect on what is displayed. After using
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003461 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller
3462 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold.
3463
3464 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'*
3465'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20)
3466 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003467 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3468 feature}
3469 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax"
3470 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more
3471 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20.
3472
3473 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'*
3474'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix,
3475 search,tag,undo")
3476 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003477 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3478 feature}
3479 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the
3480 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma separated
3481 list of items.
Bram Moolenaar05365702010-10-27 18:34:44 +02003482 NOTE: When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used.
3483 Add the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect.
3484 (rationale: the mapping may want to control opening folds itself)
3485
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003486 item commands ~
3487 all any
3488 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc.
3489 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc.
3490 insert any command in Insert mode
3491 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc.
3492 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc.
3493 percent "%"
3494 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc.
3495 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc.
3496 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command)
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003497 Also for |[s| and |]s|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003498 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc.
3499 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003500 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%")
3501 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the
3502 whole closed fold.
3503 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it
3504 very difficult to move onto a closed fold.
3505 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open
3506 when text is inserted.
3507 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or
3508 set the 'foldclose' option to "all".
3509
3510 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'*
3511'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()")
3512 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003513 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3514 feature}
3515 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed
3516 fold. See |fold-foldtext|.
3517
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003518 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
3519 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003520 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003521
3522 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
3523 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|.
3524
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003525 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'*
3526'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "")
3527 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003528 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
3529 feature}
3530 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq|
3531 operator or automatic formatting (see 'formatoptions'). When this
3532 option is empty 'formatprg' is used.
3533
3534 The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted.
3535 The |v:count| variable holds the number of lines to be formatted.
3536 The |v:char| variable holds the character that is going to be
3537 inserted if the expression is being evaluated due to
3538 automatic formatting. This can be empty. Don't insert
3539 it yet!
3540
3541 Example: >
3542 :set formatexpr=mylang#Format()
3543< This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the
3544 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload|
3545
3546 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding
3547 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as
3548 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the
3549 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will
3550 return "i" or "R" in this situation.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01003551
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003552 When the expression evaluates to non-zero Vim will fall back to using
3553 the internal format mechanism.
3554
3555 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
3556 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. That stops the option from working,
3557 since changing the buffer text is not allowed.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003558 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01003559 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003560
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003561 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'*
3562'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*")
3563 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003564 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for
3565 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'.
3566 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00003567 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003568 while still checking more characters. There must be a character
3569 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled
3570 like there is no match.
3571 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation
3572 character and white space.
3573
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02003574 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'*
3575'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt")
3576 local to buffer
3577 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic
3578 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is
3579 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can
3580 be inserted for readability.
3581 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3582 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3583 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3584 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3585
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003586 *'formatprg'* *'fp'*
3587'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar9be7c042017-01-14 14:28:30 +01003588 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003589 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003590 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003591 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00003592 such a program.
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003593 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead.
3594 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal
3595 format function will be used |C-indenting|.
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00003596 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
3597 about including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003598 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3599 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003600
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01003601 *'fsync'* *'fs'* *'nofsync'* *'nofs'*
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003602'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on)
3603 global
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003604 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a
3605 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely
3606 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This
3607 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop
3608 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that
3609 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On
3610 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always
3611 off.
3612 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files.
Bram Moolenaar340dd0f2021-10-14 17:52:23 +01003613 'fsync' also applies to |writefile()| (unless a flag is used to
3614 overrule it) and when writing undo files (see |undo-persistence|).
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003615 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3616 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003617
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003618 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'*
3619'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off)
3620 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003621 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that
3622 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag
3623 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution
3624 of all or one match. See |complex-change|.
3625
3626 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~
3627 :s/// subst. all subst. one
3628 :s///g subst. one subst. all
3629 :s///gg subst. all subst. one
3630
3631 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar21020352017-06-13 17:21:04 +02003632 DEPRECATED: Setting this option may break plugins that are not aware
3633 of this option. Also, many users get confused that adding the /g flag
3634 has the opposite effect of that it normally does.
Bram Moolenaar4072ba52020-12-23 13:56:35 +01003635 This option is not used in |Vim9| script.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003636
3637 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'*
Bram Moolenaar6e932462014-09-09 18:48:09 +02003638'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l:%m,%f:%l%m,%f %l%m")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003639 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003640 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output.
3641 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the
3642 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|.
3643
3644 *'grepprg'* *'gp'*
3645'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ",
3646 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null",
3647 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n",
3648 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ")
3649 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00003650 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003651 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command-
3652 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments
3653 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See
3654 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3655 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep"
3656 also work well with a single file: >
3657 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00003658< Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command
Bram Moolenaara6557602006-02-04 22:43:20 +00003659 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like
3660 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|.
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003661 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003662 apply equally to 'grepprg'.
3663 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found,
3664 otherwise it's "grep -n".
3665 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3666 security reasons.
3667
3668 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549*
3669'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor,
3670 ve:ver35-Cursor,
3671 o:hor50-Cursor,
3672 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor,
3673 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor,
3674 sm:block-Cursor
3675 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175",
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01003676 for Win32 console:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003677 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15,
3678 r-cr:hor30,sm:block")
3679 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003680 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01003681 for Win32 console}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003682 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01003683 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In a Win32 console, only the
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01003684 height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by specifying a
3685 block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or horizontal cursor.
Bram Moolenaar1e7813a2015-03-31 18:31:03 +02003686 For a console the 't_SI', 't_SR', and 't_EI' escape sequences are
3687 used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003688
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003689 The option is a comma separated list of parts. Each part consist of a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003690 mode-list and an argument-list:
3691 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,..
3692 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes:
3693 n Normal mode
3694 v Visual mode
3695 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
3696 if not specified)
3697 o Operator-pending mode
3698 i Insert mode
3699 r Replace mode
3700 c Command-line Normal (append) mode
3701 ci Command-line Insert mode
3702 cr Command-line Replace mode
3703 sm showmatch in Insert mode
3704 a all modes
3705 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments:
3706 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height
3707 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width
3708 block block cursor, fills the whole character
3709 [only one of the above three should be present]
3710 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking*
3711 blinkon{N}
3712 blinkoff{N}
3713 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before
3714 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that
3715 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the
3716 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one
3717 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The
3718 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250".
3719 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This
3720 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch
3721 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only
3722 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while
3723 executing a command.
3724 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see
3725 |xterm-blink|.
3726 {group-name}
3727 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font
3728 for the cursor
3729 {group-name}/{group-name}
3730 Two highlight group names, the first is used when
3731 no language mappings are used, the other when they
3732 are. |language-mapping|
3733
3734 Examples of parts:
3735 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a
3736 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor"
3737 highlight group
3738 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150
3739 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a
3740 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the
3741 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit
3742 faster.
3743
3744 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for
3745 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used
3746 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off
3747 blinking: "a:blinkon0"
3748
3749 Examples of cursor highlighting: >
3750 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE
3751 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg
3752<
3753 *'guifont'* *'gfn'*
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02003754 *E235* *E596*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003755'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "")
3756 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003757 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3758 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim.
Bram Moolenaarf720d0a2019-04-28 14:02:47 +02003759 In its simplest form the value is just one font name.
3760 See |gui-font| for the details.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003761
3762 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'*
3763 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598*
3764'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "")
3765 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003766 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
3767 with the |+xfontset| feature}
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01003768 {not available in the GTK+ GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003769 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first
3770 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See
3771 |xfontset|.
Bram Moolenaarf720d0a2019-04-28 14:02:47 +02003772
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003773 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534*
3774'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "")
3775 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003776 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3777 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used
3778 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is
Bram Moolenaarf720d0a2019-04-28 14:02:47 +02003779 used. See |gui-fontwide|.
Bram Moolenaar0f272122013-01-23 18:37:40 +01003780
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003781 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'*
3782'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50)
3783 global
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003784 {only for GTK and X11 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003785 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting
3786 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started,
3787 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003788 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003789 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the
3790 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the
3791 screen.
3792
3793 *'guioptions'* *'go'*
Bram Moolenaar2c64ca12018-10-19 16:22:31 +02003794'guioptions' 'go' string (default "egmrLtT" (MS-Windows,
3795 "t" is removed in |defaults.vim|),
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02003796 "aegimrLtT" (GTK, Motif and Athena),
3797 )
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003798 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003799 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003800 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003801 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the
3802 GUI should be used.
3803 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3804 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3805
Bram Moolenaar13568252018-03-16 20:46:58 +01003806 Valid characters are as follows:
3807 *'go-!'*
3808 '!' External commands are executed in a terminal window. Without
3809 this flag the MS-Windows GUI will open a console window to
3810 execute the command. The Unix GUI will simulate a dumb
3811 terminal to list the command output.
3812 The terminal window will be positioned at the bottom, and grow
3813 upwards as needed.
Bram Moolenaarba3ff532018-11-04 14:45:49 +01003814 *'go-a'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003815 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started,
3816 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of
3817 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the
3818 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other
3819 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode
3820 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an
3821 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text
3822 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register.
3823 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other
3824 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended.
3825 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the
3826 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to
3827 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register.
3828 The same applies to the modeless selection.
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02003829 *'go-P'*
3830 'P' Like autoselect but using the "+ register instead of the "*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01003831 register.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003832 *'go-A'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003833 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003834 applies to the modeless selection.
3835
3836 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~
3837 "" - -
3838 "a" yes yes
3839 "A" - yes
3840 "aA" yes yes
3841
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003842 *'go-c'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003843 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple
3844 choices.
Bram Moolenaar50bf7ce2019-09-15 13:17:00 +02003845 *'go-d'*
3846 'd' Use dark theme variant if available. Currently only works for
3847 GTK+ GUI.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003848 *'go-e'*
Bram Moolenaare224ffa2006-03-01 00:01:28 +00003849 'e' Add tab pages when indicated with 'showtabline'.
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003850 'guitablabel' can be used to change the text in the labels.
3851 When 'e' is missing a non-GUI tab pages line may be used.
Bram Moolenaard68071d2006-05-02 22:08:30 +00003852 The GUI tabs are only supported on some systems, currently
Bram Moolenaarb3f74062020-02-26 16:16:53 +01003853 GTK, Motif, Mac OS/X, Haiku, and MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003854 *'go-f'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003855 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell
3856 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the
3857 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you
3858 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the
3859 foreground. |gui-fork|
3860 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003861 happened already when the |gvimrc| file is read.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003862 *'go-i'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003863 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper
3864 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of
3865 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003866 *'go-m'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003867 'm' Menu bar is present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003868 *'go-M'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003869 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003870 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003871 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the |gvimrc|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003872 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +01003873 `:syntax on` and `:filetype on` commands load the menu too).
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003874 *'go-g'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003875 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If
3876 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all.
3877 Exception: Athena will always use grey menu items.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003878 *'go-t'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003879 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32,
3880 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003881 *'go-T'*
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00003882 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif, Photon
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00003883 and Athena GUIs.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003884 *'go-r'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003885 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003886 *'go-R'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003887 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3888 split window.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003889 *'go-l'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003890 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003891 *'go-L'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003892 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3893 split window.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003894 *'go-b'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003895 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on
3896 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h'
3897 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll|
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003898 *'go-h'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003899 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor
3900 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll|
3901
3902 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if
3903 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information.
3904
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003905 *'go-v'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003906 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included,
3907 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a
Bram Moolenaardad44732021-03-31 20:07:33 +02003908 vertical layout is used anyway. Not supported in GTK 3.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003909 *'go-p'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003910 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some
3911 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at
3912 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003913 before starting the GUI. Set it in your |gvimrc|. Adding or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003914 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003915 *'go-F'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003916 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|.
Bram Moolenaar8ac44152017-11-09 18:33:29 +01003917 *'go-k'*
3918 'k' Keep the GUI window size when adding/removing a scrollbar, or
3919 toolbar, tabline, etc. Instead, the behavior is similar to
3920 when the window is maximized and will adjust 'lines' and
3921 'columns' to fit to the window. Without the 'k' flag Vim will
Bram Moolenaar51b0f372017-11-18 18:52:04 +01003922 try to keep 'lines' and 'columns' the same when adding and
Bram Moolenaar8ac44152017-11-09 18:33:29 +01003923 removing GUI components.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003924
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003925 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'*
3926'guipty' boolean (default on)
3927 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003928 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3929 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for
3930 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|.
3931
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003932 *'guitablabel'* *'gtl'*
3933'guitablabel' 'gtl' string (default empty)
3934 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02003935 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003936 When nonempty describes the text to use in a label of the GUI tab
Bram Moolenaard68071d2006-05-02 22:08:30 +00003937 pages line. When empty and when the result is empty Vim will use a
3938 default label. See |setting-guitablabel| for more info.
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003939
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003940 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00003941 'guitabtooltip' is used for the tooltip, see below.
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +01003942 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
3943 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003944 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003945
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003946 Only used when the GUI tab pages line is displayed. 'e' must be
3947 present in 'guioptions'. For the non-GUI tab pages line 'tabline' is
3948 used.
3949
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00003950 *'guitabtooltip'* *'gtt'*
3951'guitabtooltip' 'gtt' string (default empty)
3952 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02003953 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00003954 When nonempty describes the text to use in a tooltip for the GUI tab
3955 pages line. When empty Vim will use a default tooltip.
3956 This option is otherwise just like 'guitablabel' above.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003957 You can include a line break. Simplest method is to use |:let|: >
3958 :let &guitabtooltip = "line one\nline two"
3959<
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00003960
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003961 *'helpfile'* *'hf'*
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01003962'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MS-Windows) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003963 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt")
3964 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003965 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be
3966 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories
3967 in 'runtimepath' will be used.
3968 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example:
3969 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003970 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003971 spaces and backslashes.
3972 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3973 security reasons.
3974
3975 *'helpheight'* *'hh'*
3976'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20)
3977 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003978 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the
3979 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the
3980 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other
3981 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is
3982 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable.
3983
3984 *'helplang'* *'hlg'*
3985'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty)
3986 global
3987 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang|
3988 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003989 Comma separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language
3990 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always
3991 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over
3992 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that
3993 language and not in the English help.
3994 Example: >
3995 :set helplang=de,it
3996< This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help
3997 files.
3998 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will
3999 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option.
4000 See |help-translated|.
4001
4002 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'*
4003'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off)
4004 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004005 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a
4006 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still
4007 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course.
4008 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer
4009 hidden although the 'hidden' option is off: When the buffer is
4010 modified, 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible, and the '!'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004011 flag was used. See also |windows.txt|.
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00004012 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004013 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|.
4014 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers.
4015 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!".
4016
4017 *'highlight'* *'hl'*
4018'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string):
Bram Moolenaar58b85342016-08-14 19:54:54 +02004019 "8:SpecialKey,~:EndOfBuffer,@:NonText,
4020 d:Directory,e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch,
4021 l:Search,m:MoreMsg,M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr,
Bram Moolenaarefae76a2019-10-27 22:54:58 +01004022 a:LineNrAbove,b:LineNrBelow,
Bram Moolenaar58b85342016-08-14 19:54:54 +02004023 N:CursorLineNr,r:Question,s:StatusLine,
4024 S:StatusLineNC,c:VertSplit,t:Title,
Bram Moolenaar9d87a372018-12-18 21:41:50 +01004025 v:Visual,V:VisualNOS,w:WarningMsg,
4026 W:WildMenu,f:Folded,F:FoldColumn,
4027 A:DiffAdd,C:DiffChange,D:DiffDelete,
4028 T:DiffText,>:SignColumn,-:Conceal,
Bram Moolenaarc8c88492018-12-27 23:59:26 +01004029 B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,R:SpellRare,
Bram Moolenaar9d87a372018-12-18 21:41:50 +01004030 L:SpellLocal,+:Pmenu,=:PmenuSel,
Bram Moolenaar21020352017-06-13 17:21:04 +02004031 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb,*:TabLine,
4032 #:TabLineSel,_:TabLineFill,!:CursorColumn,
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02004033 .:CursorLine,o:ColorColumn,q:QuickFixLine,
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +02004034 z:StatusLineTerm,Z:StatusLineTermNC")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004035 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004036 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various
4037 occasions. It is a comma separated list of character pairs. The
4038 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004039 use for that occasion. The occasions are:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004040 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map"
Bram Moolenaar58b85342016-08-14 19:54:54 +02004041 |hl-EndOfBuffer| ~ lines after the last line in the buffer
4042 |hl-NonText| @ '@' at the end of the window and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004043 characters from 'showbreak'
4044 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special
4045 things in listings
4046 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages
4047 h (obsolete, ignored)
4048 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting
4049 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch')
4050 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt|
4051 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --")
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02004052 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands, and
4053 when 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set.
Bram Moolenaarefae76a2019-10-27 22:54:58 +01004054 |hl-LineNrAbove| a line number above the cursor for when the
4055 'relativenumber' option is set.
4056 |hl-LineNrBelow| b line number below the cursor for when the
4057 'relativenumber' option is set.
Bram Moolenaara3e6bc92013-01-30 14:18:00 +01004058 |hl-CursorLineNr| N like n for when 'cursorline' or 'relativenumber' is
4059 set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004060 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions
4061 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line|
Bram Moolenaarb0d45e72017-11-05 18:19:24 +01004062 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004063 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc.
4064 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows
4065 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode
4066 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the
4067 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and
4068 |xterm-clipboard|.
4069 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages
4070 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu'
4071 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds
4072 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn'
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00004073 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode
4074 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode
4075 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode
4076 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004077 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs|
Bram Moolenaar9d87a372018-12-18 21:41:50 +01004078 |hl-Conceal| - the placeholders used for concealed characters
4079 (see 'conceallevel')
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00004080 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell|
Bram Moolenaar9855d6b2010-07-18 14:34:51 +02004081 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital |spell|
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00004082 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell|
4083 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell|
Bram Moolenaar9d87a372018-12-18 21:41:50 +01004084 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line
4085 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu selected line
4086 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar
4087 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004088
4089 The display modes are:
4090 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me")
4091 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR")
4092 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me")
4093 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se")
4094 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue")
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00004095 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce")
Bram Moolenaarcf4b00c2017-09-02 18:33:56 +02004096 t strikethrough (termcap entry "Ts" and "Te")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004097 n no highlighting
4098 - no highlighting
4099 : use a highlight group
4100 The default is used for occasions that are not included.
4101 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors|
4102 for an example.
4103 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of
4104 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type
4105 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to
4106 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion.
4107 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups.
4108
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004109 *'history'* *'hi'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004110'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 50, Vi default: 0,
4111 set to 200 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004112 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004113 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns
Bram Moolenaar78159bb2014-06-25 11:48:54 +02004114 is remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004115 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|).
Bram Moolenaar78159bb2014-06-25 11:48:54 +02004116 The maximum value is 10000.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004117 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
4118 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
4119
4120 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'*
4121'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off)
4122 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004123 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
4124 feature}
4125 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set.
4126 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
4127 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|.
4128 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4129
4130 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'*
4131'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off)
4132 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004133 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
4134 feature}
4135 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on.
4136 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard.
4137 See |rileft.txt|.
4138 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4139
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01004140 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'*
4141'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off)
4142 global
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01004143 {not available when compiled without the
4144 |+extra_search| feature}
4145 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches.
4146 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the
4147 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by
4148 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets
4149 are not applied.
4150 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|.
4151 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it
4152 off with |:nohlsearch|. This does not change the option value, as
4153 soon as you use a search command, the highlighting comes back.
4154 'redrawtime' specifies the maximum time spent on finding matches.
4155 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to
4156 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the
4157 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first
4158 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not
4159 drawn may not continue in a newly drawn line.
4160 You can specify whether the highlight status is restored on startup
4161 with the 'h' flag in 'viminfo' |viminfo-h|.
4162 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4163
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004164 *'icon'* *'noicon'*
4165'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
4166 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004167 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
4168 feature}
4169 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of
4170 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file
4171 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used.
4172 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option.
4173 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently
4174 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are
4175 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the
4176 builtin termcap).
4177 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004178 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004179 X11.
Bram Moolenaar3a991dd2014-10-02 01:41:41 +02004180 For MS-Windows the icon can be changed, see |windows-icon|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004181
4182 *'iconstring'*
4183'iconstring' string (default "")
4184 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004185 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
4186 feature}
4187 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of
4188 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on.
4189 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text
4190 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option).
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02004191 Does not work for MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004192 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
4193 restored if possible |X11|.
4194 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004195 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004196 'titlestring' for example settings.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004197 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004198 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
4199
4200 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'*
4201'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off)
4202 global
4203 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags
4204 file.
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01004205 Also see 'smartcase' and 'tagcase'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004206 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see
4207 |/ignorecase|.
4208
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004209 *'imactivatefunc'* *'imaf'*
4210'imactivatefunc' 'imaf' string (default "")
4211 global
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004212 This option specifies a function that will be called to
Bram Moolenaar2877d332017-11-26 14:56:16 +01004213 activate or deactivate the Input Method.
Bram Moolenaaref8c6172020-07-01 15:12:44 +02004214 It is not used in the MS-Windows GUI version.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004215 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4216 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004217
4218 Example: >
4219 function ImActivateFunc(active)
4220 if a:active
4221 ... do something
4222 else
4223 ... do something
4224 endif
4225 " return value is not used
4226 endfunction
4227 set imactivatefunc=ImActivateFunc
4228<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004229 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'*
4230'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "")
4231 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004232 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
Bram Moolenaar67c53842010-05-22 18:28:27 +02004233 |+GUI_GTK|} *E599*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004234 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for
4235 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control
4236 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'.
4237 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option
4238 tells Vim what the key is.
4239 Format:
4240 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING
4241
4242 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored):
4243 S Shift key
4244 L Lock key
4245 C Control key
4246 1 Mod1 key
4247 2 Mod2 key
4248 3 Mod3 key
4249 4 Mod4 key
4250 5 Mod5 key
4251 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are
4252 both shift+ctrl+space.
4253 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING.
4254
4255 Example: >
4256 :set imactivatekey=S-space
4257< "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 +
4258 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean).
4259
4260 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'*
4261'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off)
4262 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004263 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command
4264 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that).
4265 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering
4266 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented
4267 characters with dead keys.
4268
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004269 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'noimdisable'* *'noimd'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004270'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI))
4271 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004272 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable
4273 the IM when it doesn't work properly.
4274 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This
4275 may change in later releases.
4276
4277 *'iminsert'* *'imi'*
Bram Moolenaar4cf56bb2017-09-16 15:50:32 +02004278'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004279 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004280 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in
4281 Insert mode. Valid values:
4282 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
4283 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
4284 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004285 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc>
4286 this can be used: >
4287 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR>
4288< This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert
4289 mode.
4290 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode
4291 |i_CTRL-^|.
4292 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name.
4293 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f".
4294 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
4295 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
4296
Bram Moolenaar6315a9a2017-11-25 15:20:02 +01004297 You can set 'imactivatefunc' and 'imstatusfunc' to handle IME/XIM
Bram Moolenaard473c8c2018-08-11 18:00:22 +02004298 via external command if Vim is not compiled with the |+xim|,
Bram Moolenaar6315a9a2017-11-25 15:20:02 +01004299 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime|.
4300
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004301 *'imsearch'* *'ims'*
Bram Moolenaar4cf56bb2017-09-16 15:50:32 +02004302'imsearch' 'ims' number (default -1)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004303 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004304 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when
4305 entering a search pattern. Valid values:
4306 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like
4307 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern
4308 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
4309 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
4310 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
4311 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode
4312 |c_CTRL-^|.
4313 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap'
4314 option to a valid keymap name.
4315 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
4316 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
4317
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004318 *'imstatusfunc'* *'imsf'*
4319'imstatusfunc' 'imsf' string (default "")
4320 global
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004321 This option specifies a function that is called to obtain the status
4322 of Input Method. It must return a positive number when IME is active.
Bram Moolenaaref8c6172020-07-01 15:12:44 +02004323 It is not used in the MS-Windows GUI version.
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004324
4325 Example: >
4326 function ImStatusFunc()
4327 let is_active = ...do something
4328 return is_active ? 1 : 0
4329 endfunction
4330 set imstatusfunc=ImStatusFunc
4331<
4332 NOTE: This function is invoked very often. Keep it fast.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004333 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4334 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004335
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004336 *'imstyle'* *'imst'*
4337'imstyle' 'imst' number (default 1)
4338 global
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004339 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
4340 |+GUI_GTK|}
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +02004341 This option specifies the input style of Input Method:
4342 0 use on-the-spot style
4343 1 over-the-spot style
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004344 See: |xim-input-style|
4345
Bram Moolenaar24a98a02017-09-27 22:23:55 +02004346 For a long time on-the-spot style had been used in the GTK version of
4347 vim, however, it is known that it causes troubles when using mappings,
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004348 |single-repeat|, etc. Therefore over-the-spot style becomes the
4349 default now. This should work fine for most people, however if you
4350 have any problem with it, try using on-the-spot style.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004351 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4352 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004353
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004354 *'include'* *'inc'*
4355'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include")
4356 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004357 {not available when compiled without the
4358 |+find_in_path| feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004359 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004360 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default
4361 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i",
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00004362 "]I", "[d", etc.
4363 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00004364 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern
4365 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it
4366 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters
4367 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use
4368 'includeexpr' to process the matched text.
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00004369 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004370
4371 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'*
4372'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "")
4373 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004374 {not available when compiled without the
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004375 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004376 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004377 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004378 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g')
4379< The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004380
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004381 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004382 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004383 Also used for |<cfile>|.
4384
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02004385 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4386 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004387 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004388
4389 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
4390 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|.
4391
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004392 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004393'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim| if the
4394 +reltime feature is supported)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004395 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004396 {not available when compiled without the
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004397 |+extra_search| features}
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00004398 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed
4399 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern
4400 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated
4401 often, this is only useful on fast terminals.
Bram Moolenaarfc65cab2018-08-28 22:58:02 +02004402 Also applies to the pattern in commands: >
4403 :global
4404 :lvimgrep
4405 :lvimgrepadd
4406 :smagic
4407 :snomagic
4408 :sort
4409 :substitute
4410 :vglobal
4411 :vimgrep
4412 :vimgrepadd
4413< Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00004414 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You
4415 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the
4416 cursor to the match.
Bram Moolenaardc083282016-10-11 08:57:33 +02004417 You can use the CTRL-G and CTRL-T keys to move to the next and
4418 previous match. |c_CTRL-G| |c_CTRL-T|
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00004419 When compiled with the |+reltime| feature Vim only searches for about
4420 half a second. With a complicated pattern and/or a lot of text the
4421 match may not be found. This is to avoid that Vim hangs while you
4422 are typing the pattern.
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00004423 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'.
Bram Moolenaar2f058492017-11-30 20:27:52 +01004424 When 'hlsearch' is on, all matched strings are highlighted too while
4425 typing a search command. See also: 'hlsearch'.
Bram Moolenaard473c8c2018-08-11 18:00:22 +02004426 If you don't want to turn 'hlsearch' on, but want to highlight all
4427 matches while searching, you can turn on and off 'hlsearch' with
4428 autocmd. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar2e51d9a2017-10-29 16:40:30 +01004429 augroup vimrc-incsearch-highlight
4430 autocmd!
Bram Moolenaarf8f8b2e2017-11-02 19:08:48 +01004431 autocmd CmdlineEnter /,\? :set hlsearch
4432 autocmd CmdlineLeave /,\? :set nohlsearch
Bram Moolenaar2e51d9a2017-10-29 16:40:30 +01004433 augroup END
4434<
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00004435 CTRL-L can be used to add one character from after the current match
Bram Moolenaara9dc3752010-07-11 20:46:53 +02004436 to the command line. If 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase' are set and the
4437 command line has no uppercase characters, the added character is
4438 converted to lowercase.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00004439 CTRL-R CTRL-W can be used to add the word at the end of the current
4440 match, excluding the characters that were already typed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004441 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4442
4443 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'*
4444'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "")
4445 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004446 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
4447 or |+eval| features}
4448 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line.
4449 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and
4450 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option.
4451 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and
Bram Moolenaar20f90cf2011-05-19 12:22:51 +02004452 'smartindent' indenting. When 'lisp' is set, this option is
4453 overridden by the Lisp indentation algorithm.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004454 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting.
4455 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00004456 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004457 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around).
4458 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It
4459 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is
4460 used for the indent).
4461 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()|
4462 and |lispindent()|.
4463 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must
4464 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the
4465 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved.
4466 Normally this option would be set to call a function: >
4467 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent()
4468< Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains
4469 "msg".
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004470 See |indent-expression|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01004471 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004472
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02004473 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4474 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004475 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004476
4477 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
4478 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|.
4479
4480
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004481 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'*
Bram Moolenaarce655742019-01-31 14:12:57 +01004482'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},0),0],:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004483 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004484 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
4485 feature}
4486 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
4487 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty.
4488 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|.
4489 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|.
4490
4491 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'*
4492'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off)
4493 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004494 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004495 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted depending
4496 on the typed text. If the typed text contains a lowercase letter
4497 where the match has an upper case letter, the completed part is made
4498 lowercase. If the typed text has no lowercase letters and the match
4499 has a lowercase letter where the typed text has an uppercase letter,
4500 and there is a letter before it, the completed part is made uppercase.
4501 With 'noinfercase' the match is used as-is.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004502
4503 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'*
4504'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off)
4505 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004506 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful
4507 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|.
4508 These Insert mode commands will be useful:
4509 - Use the cursor keys to move around.
Bram Moolenaardc1f1642016-08-16 18:33:43 +02004510 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|. When
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004511 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off.
4512 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004513 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use
Bram Moolenaar488c6512005-08-11 20:09:58 +00004514 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor
4515 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004516
4517 These items change when 'insertmode' is set:
4518 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode.
4519 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps.
4520 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode.
4521 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted.
4522 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z*
4523 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like
4524 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same
4525 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set.
4526 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used.
4527
4528 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4529
4530 *'isfname'* *'isf'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01004531'isfname' 'isf' string (default for Win32:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004532 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,="
4533 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:"
4534 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~"
4535 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,="
4536 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=")
4537 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004538 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and
4539 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004540 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004541 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
4542 characters up to 255 are specified with this option.
4543 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004544 Think twice before adding white space to this option. Although a
4545 space may appear inside a file name, the effect will be that Vim
4546 doesn't know where a file name starts or ends when doing completion.
4547 It most likely works better without a space in 'isfname'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004548
4549 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to
4550 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit
4551 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special
4552 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file
4553 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The
4554 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for
4555 cmd.exe.
4556
4557 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004558 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two
4559 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004560 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does
4561 not work for digits). Example:
4562 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range
4563 128 to 140 and '#' to 43)
4564 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range
4565 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left
4566 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is
4567 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the
4568 option or the end of a range. Example:
4569 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^')
4570 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE
4571 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z,
4572 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples:
4573 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004574 case ASCII letters.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004575 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character.
4576 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is
4577 expected. Example:
4578 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore.
4579 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example:
4580 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding
4581 comma, plus <Tab>.
4582 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
4583
4584 *'isident'* *'isi'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01004585'isident' 'isi' string (default for Win32:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004586 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
4587 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255")
4588 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004589 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers.
4590 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a
4591 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004592 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02004593 option. For '@' only characters up to 255 are used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004594 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004595 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004596 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead.
4597
4598 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01004599'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for Win32:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004600 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
4601 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255"
4602 Vi default: "@,48-57,_")
4603 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004604 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands:
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004605 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02004606 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For '@'
Bram Moolenaar4c295022021-05-02 17:19:11 +02004607 characters above 255 check the "word" character class (any character
4608 that is not white space or punctuation).
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02004609 For C programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004610 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except
4611 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that
4612 command).
4613 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included.
Bram Moolenaarb8060fe2016-01-19 22:29:28 +01004614 This option also influences syntax highlighting, unless the syntax
4615 uses |:syn-iskeyword|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004616 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
4617 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
4618
4619 *'isprint'* *'isp'*
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02004620'isprint' 'isp' string (default for Win32 and macOS:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004621 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255")
4622 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004623 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the
4624 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from
4625 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly,
4626 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See
4627 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option.
4628
4629 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters:
4630 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_"
4631 32 - 126 always single characters
4632 127 "^?"
4633 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_"
4634 160 - 254 "| " - "|~"
4635 255 "~?"
4636 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are
4637 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte.
4638 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are
4639 displayed as <xx>.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004640 The SpecialKey highlighting will be used for unprintable characters.
4641 |hl-SpecialKey|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004642
4643 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
4644 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character
4645 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a
4646 replacement character will be shown.
4647 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>.
4648 There is no option to specify these characters.
4649
4650 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'*
4651'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on)
4652 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004653 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command.
4654 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'.
4655 Otherwise only one space is inserted.
4656 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
4657
4658 *'key'*
4659'key' string (default "")
4660 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar996343d2010-07-04 22:20:21 +02004661 {only available when compiled with the |+cryptv|
4662 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004663 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer.
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02004664 See |encryption| and 'cryptmethod'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004665 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed
4666 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: >
4667 :set key=
4668< It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or
4669 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't
4670 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it,
4671 be careful not to make a typing error!
Bram Moolenaard58e9292011-02-09 17:07:58 +01004672 You can use "&key" in an expression to detect whether encryption is
4673 enabled. When 'key' is set it returns "*****" (five stars).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004674
4675 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544*
4676'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "")
4677 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004678 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap|
4679 feature}
4680 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|.
4681 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of
4682 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective.
4683 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00004684 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004685
4686 *'keymodel'* *'km'*
4687'keymodel' 'km' string (default "")
4688 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004689 List of comma separated words, which enable special things that keys
4690 can do. These values can be used:
4691 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either
4692 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being
4693 present in 'selectmode').
4694 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection.
4695 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>,
4696 <PageUp> and <PageDown>.
4697 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
4698
4699 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'*
4700'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help",
Bram Moolenaar2ff8b642016-05-24 10:46:45 +02004701 VMS: "help")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004702 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004703 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are
4704 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal
4705 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty
4706 value did this, which is now deprecated.)
Bram Moolenaar2ff8b642016-05-24 10:46:45 +02004707 When the first character is ":", the command is invoked as a Vim
4708 Ex command prefixed with [count].
4709 When "man", "man -s" or an Ex command is used, Vim will automatically
4710 translate a count for the "K" command and pass it as the first
4711 argument. For "man -s" the "-s" is removed when there is no count.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004712 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
4713 Example: >
4714 :set keywordprg=man\ -s
4715< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4716 security reasons.
4717
4718 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358*
4719'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "")
4720 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004721 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
4722 feature}
4723 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004724 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01004725 inserted directly. When in Normal mode the 'langmap' option takes
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004726 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning
4727 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to
4728 be able to execute Normal mode commands.
4729 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are
4730 mapped in Insert mode.
Bram Moolenaarb17893a2020-03-14 08:19:51 +01004731 Also consider setting 'langremap' to off, to prevent 'langmap' from
4732 applying to characters resulting from a mapping.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02004733 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4734 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004735
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00004736 Example (for Greek, in UTF-8): *greek* >
4737 :set langmap=ΑA,ΒB,ΨC,ΔD,ΕE,ΦF,ΓG,ΗH,ΙI,ΞJ,ΚK,ΛL,ΜM,ΝN,ΟO,ΠP,QQ,ΡR,ΣS,ΤT,ΘU,ΩV,WW,ΧX,ΥY,ΖZ,αa,βb,ψc,δd,εe,φf,γg,ηh,ιi,ξj,κk,λl,μm,νn,οo,πp,qq,ρr,σs,τt,θu,ωv,ςw,χx,υy,ζz
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004738< Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): >
4739 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ
4740<
4741 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each
4742 part can be in one of two forms:
4743 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately
4744 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC".
4745 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to"
4746 characters. Example: "abc;ABC"
4747 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE"
4748 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are
Bram Moolenaar4f4d51a2020-10-11 13:57:40 +02004749 ";", ',', '"', '|' and backslash itself.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004750
4751 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch
4752 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will
4753 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the
4754 langmap mappings) in the following cases:
4755 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings)
4756 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R
4757 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings
4758 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by
4759 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time
4760 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings.
4761 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time!
4762
4763 *'langmenu'* *'lm'*
4764'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "")
4765 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004766 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and
4767 |+multi_lang| features}
4768 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded
4769 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': >
4770 "lang/menu_" . &langmenu . ".vim"
4771< (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no
4772 matter what $LANG is set to: >
4773 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1
4774< When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00004775 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004776 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use
4777 the English menus: >
4778 :set langmenu=none
4779< This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype
4780 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting
4781 this option has no effect. But you could do this: >
4782 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim
4783 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1
4784 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim
4785< Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself!
4786
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01004787 *'langnoremap'* *'lnr'* *'nolangnoremap'* *'nolnr'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004788'langnoremap' 'lnr' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004789 global
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004790 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
4791 feature}
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004792 This is just like 'langremap' but with the value inverted. It only
4793 exists for backwards compatibility. When setting 'langremap' then
4794 'langnoremap' is set to the inverted value, and the other way around.
4795
4796 *'langremap'* *'lrm'* *'nolangremap'* *'nolrm'*
Bram Moolenaarb17893a2020-03-14 08:19:51 +01004797'langremap' 'lrm' boolean (default on, set to off in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004798 global
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004799 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
4800 feature}
4801 When off, setting 'langmap' does not apply to characters resulting from
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004802 a mapping. This basically means, if you noticed that setting
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004803 'langmap' disables some of your mappings, try resetting this option.
4804 This option defaults to on for backwards compatibility. Set it off if
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004805 that works for you to avoid mappings to break.
4806
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004807 *'laststatus'* *'ls'*
4808'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1)
4809 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004810 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a
4811 status line:
4812 0: never
4813 1: only if there are at least two windows
4814 2: always
4815 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several
4816 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line|
4817
4818 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'*
4819'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off)
4820 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004821 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while
4822 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004823 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004824 update use |:redraw|.
4825
4826 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'*
4827'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off)
4828 local to window
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004829 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004830 feature}
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02004831 If on, Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004832 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike
4833 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file,
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02004834 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents.
4835 If 'breakindent' is set, line is visually indented. Then, the value
4836 of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines. This option
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02004837 is not used when the 'wrap' option is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004838 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed
4839 with the right amount of white space.
4840
4841 *'lines'* *E593*
4842'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height)
4843 global
4844 Number of lines of the Vim window.
4845 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00004846 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004847 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
4848 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
4849 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
4850 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can
4851 use this command to get the tallest window possible: >
4852 :set lines=999
Bram Moolenaarf4d11452005-12-02 00:46:37 +00004853< Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000.
Bram Moolenaardc1f1642016-08-16 18:33:43 +02004854 If you get fewer lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004855 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
4856 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up.
4857
4858 *'linespace'* *'lsp'*
4859'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI)
4860 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004861 {only in the GUI}
4862 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font
4863 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other.
4864 When non-zero there is room for underlining.
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00004865 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have
4866 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set
4867 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems
4868 though!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004869
4870 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'*
4871'lisp' boolean (default off)
4872 local to buffer
4873 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
4874 feature}
4875 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for
4876 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with
4877 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p'
4878 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or
4879 better. Also see 'lispwords'.
4880 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the
4881 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than
4882 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty.
4883 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004884
4885 *'lispwords'* *'lw'*
4886'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long)
Bram Moolenaaraf6c1312014-03-12 18:55:58 +01004887 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004888 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
4889 feature}
4890 Comma separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting.
4891 |'lisp'|
4892
4893 *'list'* *'nolist'*
4894'list' boolean (default off)
4895 local to window
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004896 List mode: Show tabs as CTRL-I is displayed, display $ after end of
4897 line. Useful to see the difference between tabs and spaces and for
4898 trailing blanks. Further changed by the 'listchars' option.
4899
4900 The cursor is displayed at the start of the space a Tab character
4901 occupies, not at the end as usual in Normal mode. To get this cursor
4902 position while displaying Tabs with spaces, use: >
Bram Moolenaardd007ed2013-07-09 15:44:17 +02004903 :set list lcs=tab:\ \
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004904<
4905 Note that list mode will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth'
4906 or 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004907 changing the way tabs are displayed.
4908
4909 *'listchars'* *'lcs'*
4910'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$")
Bram Moolenaareed9d462021-02-15 20:38:25 +01004911 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaarf9d5ca12010-08-01 16:13:51 +02004912 Strings to use in 'list' mode and for the |:list| command. It is a
4913 comma separated list of string settings.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004914 *lcs-eol*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004915 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When
4916 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the
4917 line.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004918 *lcs-tab*
Bram Moolenaar83a52172019-01-16 22:41:54 +01004919 tab:xy[z] Two or three characters to be used to show a tab.
4920 The third character is optional.
4921
4922 tab:xy The 'x' is always used, then 'y' as many times as will
4923 fit. Thus "tab:>-" displays:
4924 >
4925 >-
4926 >--
4927 etc.
4928
4929 tab:xyz The 'z' is always used, then 'x' is prepended, and
4930 then 'y' is used as many times as will fit. Thus
4931 "tab:<->" displays:
4932 >
4933 <>
4934 <->
4935 <-->
4936 etc.
4937
4938 When "tab:" is omitted, a tab is shown as ^I.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004939 *lcs-space*
4940 space:c Character to show for a space. When omitted, spaces
4941 are left blank.
zeertzjqf14b8ba2021-09-10 16:58:30 +02004942 *lcs-multispace*
4943 multispace:c...
4944 One or more characters to use cyclically to show for
4945 multiple consecutive spaces. Overrides the "space"
4946 setting, except for single spaces. When omitted, the
4947 "space" setting is used. For example,
4948 `:set listchars=multispace:---+` shows ten consecutive
4949 spaces as:
4950 ---+---+--
Bram Moolenaar91478ae2021-02-03 15:58:13 +01004951 *lcs-lead*
4952 lead:c Character to show for leading spaces. When omitted,
zeertzjqf14b8ba2021-09-10 16:58:30 +02004953 leading spaces are blank. Overrides the "space" and
4954 "multispace" settings for leading spaces. You can
4955 combine it with "tab:", for example: >
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01004956 :set listchars+=tab:>-,lead:.
4957< *lcs-trail*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004958 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted,
zeertzjqf14b8ba2021-09-10 16:58:30 +02004959 trailing spaces are blank. Overrides the "space" and
4960 "multispace" settings for trailing spaces.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004961 *lcs-extends*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004962 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is
4963 off and the line continues beyond the right of the
4964 screen.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004965 *lcs-precedes*
Bram Moolenaarbffba7f2019-09-20 17:00:17 +02004966 precedes:c Character to show in the first visible column of the
4967 physical line, when there is text preceding the
4968 character visible in the first column.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004969 *lcs-conceal*
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02004970 conceal:c Character to show in place of concealed text, when
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004971 'conceallevel' is set to 1.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004972 *lcs-nbsp*
Bram Moolenaar73284b92015-05-04 17:28:22 +02004973 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space character
4974 (0xA0 (160 decimal) and U+202F). Left blank when
4975 omitted.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004976
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004977 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004978 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00004979 characters are allowed. All characters must be single width.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004980
4981 Examples: >
4982 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:-
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00004983 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:%
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004984 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:<
4985< The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and
Bram Moolenaar34cc7d82021-09-21 20:09:51 +02004986 "precedes". "SpecialKey" will be used for "tab", "nbsp", "space",
4987 "multispace", "lead" and "trail".
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004988 |hl-NonText| |hl-SpecialKey|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004989
4990 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'*
4991'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on)
4992 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004993 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|.
4994 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading
4995 of plugins.
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02004996 Note that using the "-u NONE", "-u DEFAULTS" and "--noplugin" command
4997 line arguments reset this option. See |-u| and |--noplugin|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004998
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01004999 *'luadll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005000'luadll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005001 global
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005002 {only available when compiled with the |+lua/dyn|
5003 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005004 Specifies the name of the Lua shared library. The default is
5005 DYNAMIC_LUA_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005006 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005007 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5008 security reasons.
5009
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +00005010 *'macatsui'* *'nomacatsui'*
5011'macatsui' boolean (default on)
5012 global
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02005013 {not supported}
5014 No longer supported, as the Mac OS X GUI code was removed.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005015
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005016 *'magic'* *'nomagic'*
5017'magic' boolean (default on)
5018 global
5019 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns.
5020 See |pattern|.
Bram Moolenaar64d8e252016-09-06 22:12:34 +02005021 WARNING: Switching this option off most likely breaks plugins! That
5022 is because many patterns assume it's on and will fail when it's off.
5023 Only switch it off when working with old Vi scripts. In any other
5024 situation write patterns that work when 'magic' is on. Include "\M"
5025 when you want to |/\M|.
Bram Moolenaar4072ba52020-12-23 13:56:35 +01005026 In |Vim9| script the value of 'magic' is ignored, patterns behave like
5027 it is always set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005028
5029 *'makeef'* *'mef'*
5030'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "")
5031 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005032 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
5033 feature}
5034 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|)
5035 and the |:grep| command.
5036 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used.
5037 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name
5038 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an
5039 existing file.
5040 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that.
5041 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5042 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
5043 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5044 security reasons.
5045
Bram Moolenaar2c7292d2017-03-05 17:43:31 +01005046 *'makeencoding'* *'menc'*
5047'makeencoding' 'menc' string (default "")
5048 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar2c7292d2017-03-05 17:43:31 +01005049 Encoding used for reading the output of external commands. When empty,
5050 encoding is not converted.
5051 This is used for `:make`, `:lmake`, `:grep`, `:lgrep`, `:grepadd`,
5052 `:lgrepadd`, `:cfile`, `:cgetfile`, `:caddfile`, `:lfile`, `:lgetfile`,
5053 and `:laddfile`.
5054
5055 This would be mostly useful when you use MS-Windows and set 'encoding'
5056 to "utf-8". If |+iconv| is enabled and GNU libiconv is used, setting
5057 'makeencoding' to "char" has the same effect as setting to the system
5058 locale encoding. Example: >
5059 :set encoding=utf-8
5060 :set makeencoding=char " system locale is used
5061<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005062 *'makeprg'* *'mp'*
5063'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS")
5064 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005065 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01005066 This option may contain '%' and '#' characters (see |:_%| and |:_#|),
5067 which are expanded to the current and alternate file name. Use |::S|
Bram Moolenaar26df0922014-02-23 23:39:13 +01005068 to escape file names in case they contain special characters.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005069 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
5070 about including spaces and backslashes.
5071 Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set" and once for
5072 the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter called
5073 "myfilter" do it like this: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005074 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter
5075< The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify
5076 where the arguments will be included, for example: >
5077 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*}
5078< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5079 security reasons.
5080
5081 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'*
5082'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]")
5083 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005084 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the
Bram Moolenaara3e6bc92013-01-30 14:18:00 +01005085 other.
5086 Only character pairs are allowed that are different, thus you cannot
5087 jump between two double quotes.
5088 The characters must be separated by a colon.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005089 The pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02005090 '>' (for HTML): >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005091 :set mps+=<:>
5092
5093< A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an
5094 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: >
5095 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:;
5096
5097< For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +01005098 the $VIMRUNTIME/pack/dist/opt/matchit directory. |add-local-help|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005099
5100 *'matchtime'* *'mat'*
5101'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5)
5102 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005103 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is
5104 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that
5105 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi.
5106
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00005107 *'maxcombine'* *'mco'*
5108'maxcombine' 'mco' number (default 2)
5109 global
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00005110 The maximum number of combining characters supported for displaying.
5111 Only used when 'encoding' is "utf-8".
5112 The default is OK for most languages. Hebrew may require 4.
5113 Maximum value is 6.
5114 Even when this option is set to 2 you can still edit text with more
5115 combining characters, you just can't see them. Use |g8| or |ga|.
5116 See |mbyte-combining|.
5117
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005118 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'*
5119'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100)
5120 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005121 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005122 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005123 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally
5124 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with
5125 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use
5126 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted.
Bram Moolenaarbc2eada2017-01-02 21:27:47 +01005127 Increasing this limit above 200 also changes the maximum for Ex
Bram Moolenaar0b0f0992018-05-22 21:41:30 +02005128 command recursion, see |E169|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005129 See also |:function|.
5130
5131 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223*
5132'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000)
5133 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005134 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a
5135 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like
5136 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg",
5137 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also
5138 |key-mapping|.
5139
5140 *'maxmem'* *'mm'*
5141'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system
5142 dependent) or half the amount of memory
5143 available)
5144 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005145 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this
5146 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01005147 other memory to be freed.
5148 The maximum usable value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a
5149 limit.
5150 The value is ignored when 'swapfile' is off.
5151 Also see 'maxmemtot'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005152
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005153 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'*
5154'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000)
5155 global
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005156 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005157 The maximum value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a limit.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005158 *E363*
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005159 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message and mostly
5160 behaves like CTRL-C was typed.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005161 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very
5162 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern
5163 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better.
Bram Moolenaarfd358112018-07-07 23:21:31 +02005164 Might also happen on redraw, when syntax rules try to match a complex
5165 text structure.
5166 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit, in
5167 which case you get an "Out of memory" error instead.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005168
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005169 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'*
5170'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system
5171 dependent) or half the amount of memory
5172 available)
5173 global
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005174 Maximum amount of memory in Kbyte to use for all buffers together.
5175 The maximum usable value is about 2000000 (2 Gbyte). Use this to work
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01005176 without a limit.
5177 On 64 bit machines higher values might work. But hey, do you really
5178 need more than 2 Gbyte for text editing? Keep in mind that text is
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005179 stored in the swap file, one can edit files > 2 Gbyte anyway. We do
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01005180 need the memory to store undo info.
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01005181 Buffers with 'swapfile' off still count to the total amount of memory
5182 used.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005183 Also see 'maxmem'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005184
5185 *'menuitems'* *'mis'*
5186'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25)
5187 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005188 {not available when compiled without the |+menu|
5189 feature}
5190 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are
5191 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this
5192 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first.
5193
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00005194 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'*
5195'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500")
5196 global
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00005197 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
5198 feature}
5199 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the
5200 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but
5201 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used
5202 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why
5203 this tuning is complicated.
5204
5205 There are three numbers, separated by commas:
5206 {start},{inc},{added}
5207
5208 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start}
5209 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any
5210 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of
5211 memory that is available to Vim.
5212
5213 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the
5214 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another
5215 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after
5216 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory
5217 will be allocated.
5218
5219 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before
5220 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra
5221 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller
5222 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's
5223 slower.
5224
5225 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and
5226 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If
5227 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: >
5228 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800
5229< If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some
5230 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to.
5231
Bram Moolenaar07607392019-05-26 19:20:43 +02005232 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|.
5233
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005234 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'*
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +00005235'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on (off for root),
5236 Vi default: off)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005237 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02005238 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
5239 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
5240 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
5241
5242 *'modelineexpr'* *'mle'* *'nomodelineexpr'* *'nomle'*
5243'modelineexpr' 'mle' boolean (default: off)
5244 global
5245 When on allow some options that are an expression to be set in the
5246 modeline. Check the option for whether it is affected by
5247 'modelineexpr'. Also see |modeline|.
Bram Moolenaar1c6fd1e2019-05-23 22:11:59 +02005248 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5249 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02005250
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005251 *'modelines'* *'mls'*
5252'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5)
5253 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005254 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
5255 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
5256 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
5257 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5258 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5259
5260 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'*
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02005261 *E21*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005262'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on)
5263 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005264 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and
5265 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed.
Bram Moolenaar369b6f52017-01-17 12:22:32 +01005266 Can be reset on startup with the |-M| command line argument.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005267
5268 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'*
5269'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off)
5270 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005271 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set
5272 when:
5273 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the
5274 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the
5275 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the
5276 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from
5277 when it was written.
5278 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original
5279 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or
5280 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original
5281 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be
5282 reset.
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01005283 Similarly for 'eol' and 'bomb'.
Bram Moolenaar5302d9e2011-09-14 17:55:08 +02005284 This option is not set when a change is made to the buffer as the
5285 result of a BufNewFile, BufRead/BufReadPost, BufWritePost,
5286 FileAppendPost or VimLeave autocommand event. See |gzip-example| for
5287 an explanation.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005288 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but
5289 will be ignored.
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01005290 Note that the text may actually be the same, e.g. 'modified' is set
5291 when using "rA" on an "A".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005292
5293 *'more'* *'nomore'*
5294'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
5295 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005296 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get
5297 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the
5298 listing continues until finished.
5299 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5300 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5301
Bram Moolenaar98a29d02021-01-18 19:55:44 +01005302 *'mouse'*
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01005303'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI and Win32,
Bram Moolenaar5b418992019-10-27 18:50:25 +01005304 set to "a" or "nvi" in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005305 global
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01005306 Enable the use of the mouse. Works for most terminals (xterm, Win32
5307 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, *BSD console with sysmouse and Linux console
5308 with gpm). For using the mouse in the GUI, see |gui-mouse|. The
5309 mouse can be enabled for different modes:
Bram Moolenaar7f2e9d72017-11-11 20:58:53 +01005310 n Normal mode and Terminal modes
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005311 v Visual mode
5312 i Insert mode
5313 c Command-line mode
5314 h all previous modes when editing a help file
5315 a all previous modes
5316 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02005317 Normally you would enable the mouse in all five modes with: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005318 :set mouse=a
Bram Moolenaar5b418992019-10-27 18:50:25 +01005319< If your terminal can't overrule the mouse events going to the
5320 application, use: >
5321 :set mouse=nvi
Bram Moolenaar65e0d772020-06-14 17:29:55 +02005322< Then you can press ":", select text for the system, and press Esc to go
Bram Moolenaar5b418992019-10-27 18:50:25 +01005323 back to Vim using the mouse events.
5324 In |defaults.vim| "nvi" is used if the 'term' option is not matching
5325 "xterm".
5326
5327 When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005328 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor.
5329
5330 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|.
5331
5332 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005333 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005334 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed.
5335 Also see the 'clipboard' option.
5336
5337 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'*
5338'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off)
5339 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005340 {only works in the GUI}
5341 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated.
5342 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the
5343 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the
5344 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as
5345 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally.
Bram Moolenaar5ef1c6a2019-11-10 22:09:11 +01005346 MS-Windows: Also see 'scrollfocus' for what window is scrolled when
Bram Moolenaar1d9215b2020-01-25 13:27:42 +01005347 using the mouse scroll wheel.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005348
5349 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'*
5350'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on)
5351 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005352 {only works in the GUI}
5353 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed.
5354 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved.
5355
5356 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'*
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01005357'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for Win32)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005358 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005359 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what
5360 the right mouse button is used for:
5361 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works
5362 like in an xterm.
5363 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left
5364 mouse button extends a selection. This works like
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005365 with Microsoft Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005366 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the
5367 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the
5368 selected operation will act upon the clicked object.
5369 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005370 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005371 course, that right clicking outside a selection will
5372 end Visual mode.
5373 Overview of what button does what for each model:
5374 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~
5375 left click place cursor place cursor
5376 left drag start selection start selection
5377 shift-left search word extend selection
5378 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor)
5379 right drag extend selection -
5380 middle click paste paste
5381
5382 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu.
5383 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|.
5384
5385 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings.
5386 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless
5387 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly).
5388
5389 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
5390
5391 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547*
Bram Moolenaarf6b40102019-02-22 15:24:03 +01005392'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i-r:beam,s:updown,sd:udsizing,
5393 vs:leftright,vd:lrsizing,m:no,
5394 ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005395 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005396 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape|
5397 feature}
5398 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in
5399 different modes. The option is a comma separated list of parts, much
5400 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list
5401 and an argument-list:
5402 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,..
5403 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations:
5404 In a normal window: ~
5405 n Normal mode
5406 v Visual mode
5407 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
5408 if not specified)
5409 o Operator-pending mode
5410 i Insert mode
5411 r Replace mode
5412
5413 Others: ~
5414 c appending to the command-line
5415 ci inserting in the command-line
5416 cr replacing in the command-line
5417 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts
5418 ml idem, but cursor in the last line
5419 e any mode, pointer below last window
5420 s any mode, pointer on a status line
5421 sd any mode, while dragging a status line
5422 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line
5423 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line
5424 a everywhere
5425
5426 The shape is one of the following:
5427 avail name looks like ~
5428 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer
5429 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!)
5430 w x beam I-beam
5431 w x updown up-down sizing arrows
5432 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows
5433 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer
5434 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer
5435 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing
5436 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing
5437 x crosshair like a big thin +
5438 x hand1 black hand
5439 x hand2 white hand
5440 x pencil what you write with
5441 x question big ?
5442 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up
5443 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up
5444 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h)
5445
5446 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32,
5447 x for X11.
5448 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse
5449 pointer.
5450
5451 Example: >
5452 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no
5453< will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and
5454 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since
5455 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.)
5456
5457 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'*
5458'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500)
5459 global
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01005460 Only for GUI, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005461 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be
5462 recognized as a multi click.
5463
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02005464 *'mzschemedll'*
5465'mzschemedll' string (default depends on the build)
5466 global
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02005467 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn|
5468 feature}
5469 Specifies the name of the MzScheme shared library. The default is
5470 DYNAMIC_MZSCH_DLL which was specified at compile time.
5471 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaarb0d45e72017-11-05 18:19:24 +01005472 The value must be set in the |vimrc| script or earlier. In the
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +01005473 startup, before the |load-plugins| step.
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02005474 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5475 security reasons.
5476
5477 *'mzschemegcdll'*
5478'mzschemegcdll' string (default depends on the build)
5479 global
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02005480 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn|
5481 feature}
5482 Specifies the name of the MzScheme GC shared library. The default is
5483 DYNAMIC_MZGC_DLL which was specified at compile time.
5484 The value can be equal to 'mzschemedll' if it includes the GC code.
5485 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5486 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5487 security reasons.
5488
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005489 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'*
5490'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100)
5491 global
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005492 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme|
5493 feature}
5494 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads.
5495 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01005496 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
5497 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005498
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005499 *'nrformats'* *'nf'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02005500'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "bin,octal,hex",
5501 set to "bin,hex" in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005502 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005503 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the
5504 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number
5505 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands.
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00005506 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005507 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005508 letter index a), b), etc. *octal-nrformats*
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00005509 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005510 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010".
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00005511 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005512 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on
5513 "0x100" results in "0x0ff".
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005514 bin If included, numbers starting with "0b" or "0B" will be
5515 considered to be binary. Example: Using CTRL-X on
5516 "0b1000" subtracts one, resulting in "0b0111".
Bram Moolenaaraaad9952020-05-31 15:08:59 +02005517 unsigned If included, numbers are recognized as unsigned. Thus a
5518 leading dash or negative sign won't be considered as part of
5519 the number. Examples:
5520 Using CTRL-X on "2020" in "9-2020" results in "9-2019"
5521 (without "unsigned" it would become "9-2021").
5522 Using CTRL-A on "2020" in "9-2020" results in "9-2021"
5523 (without "unsigned" it would become "9-2019").
Bram Moolenaaracc22402020-06-07 21:07:18 +02005524 Using CTRL-X on "0" or CTRL-A on "18446744073709551615"
5525 (2^64 - 1) has no effect, overflow is prevented.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005526 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always
5527 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not
5528 recognized as octal or hex.
5529
5530 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'*
5531'number' 'nu' boolean (default off)
5532 local to window
5533 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is
5534 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of
5535 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set).
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005536 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
5537 number.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005538 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
5539 characters are put before the number.
Bram Moolenaar61d35bd2012-03-28 20:51:51 +02005540 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for
5541 the number.
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02005542 *number_relativenumber*
5543 The 'relativenumber' option changes the displayed number to be
5544 relative to the cursor. Together with 'number' there are these
5545 four combinations (cursor in line 3):
5546
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005547 'nonu' 'nu' 'nonu' 'nu'
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02005548 'nornu' 'nornu' 'rnu' 'rnu'
5549
5550 |apple | 1 apple | 2 apple | 2 apple
5551 |pear | 2 pear | 1 pear | 1 pear
5552 |nobody | 3 nobody | 0 nobody |3 nobody
5553 |there | 4 there | 1 there | 1 there
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005554
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005555 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'*
5556'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8)
5557 local to window
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005558 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak|
5559 feature}
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005560 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02005561 when the 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set or printing lines
5562 with a line number. Since one space is always between the number and
5563 the text, there is one less character for the number itself.
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005564 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02005565 fit the highest line number in the buffer respectively the number of
5566 rows in the window, depending on whether 'number' or 'relativenumber'
5567 is set. Thus with the Vim default of 4 there is room for a line number
5568 up to 999. When the buffer has 1000 lines five columns will be used.
Bram Moolenaarf8a07122019-07-01 22:06:07 +02005569 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 20.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01005570 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5571 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005572
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +00005573 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'*
5574'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty)
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00005575 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005576 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
Bram Moolenaare2c453d2019-08-21 14:37:09 +02005577 feature}
Bram Moolenaarc7486e02005-12-29 22:48:26 +00005578 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni
5579 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00005580 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
5581 invoked and what it should return.
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00005582 This option is usually set by a filetype plugin:
Bram Moolenaar9c102382006-05-03 21:26:49 +00005583 |:filetype-plugin-on|
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02005584 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5585 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00005586
5587
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005588 *'opendevice'* *'odev'* *'noopendevice'* *'noodev'*
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00005589'opendevice' 'odev' boolean (default off)
5590 global
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01005591 {only for MS-Windows}
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00005592 Enable reading and writing from devices. This may get Vim stuck on a
5593 device that can be opened but doesn't actually do the I/O. Therefore
5594 it is off by default.
5595 Note that on MS-Windows editing "aux.h", "lpt1.txt" and the like also
5596 result in editing a device.
5597
5598
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00005599 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'*
5600'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty)
5601 global
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00005602 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator.
5603 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example.
5604
5605 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5606 security reasons.
5607
5608
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02005609 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'*
5610'osfiletype' 'oft' string (default: "")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005611 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02005612 This option was supported on RISC OS, which has been removed.
5613
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005614
Bram Moolenaarf6fee0e2016-02-21 23:02:49 +01005615 *'packpath'* *'pp'*
5616'packpath' 'pp' string (default: see 'runtimepath')
Bram Moolenaarf6fee0e2016-02-21 23:02:49 +01005617 Directories used to find packages. See |packages|.
5618
5619
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005620 *'paragraphs'* *'para'*
Bram Moolenaar57e48462008-03-12 16:38:55 +00005621'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP TPHPLIPpLpItpplpipbp")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005622 global
5623 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs
5624 of two letters (see |object-motions|).
5625
5626 *'paste'* *'nopaste'*
5627'paste' boolean (default off)
5628 global
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005629 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy
5630 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005631 unexpected effects.
5632 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005633 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005634 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste'
5635 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the
5636 mouse clicks itself.
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00005637 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in
5638 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting
5639 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button
5640 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005641 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on):
5642 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled
5643 - abbreviations are disabled
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005644 - 'autoindent' is reset
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02005645 - 'expandtab' is reset
Bram Moolenaar4d8f4762021-06-27 15:18:56 +02005646 - 'hkmap' is reset
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005647 - 'revins' is reset
5648 - 'ruler' is reset
5649 - 'showmatch' is reset
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02005650 - 'smarttab' is reset
5651 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0
5652 - 'textwidth' is set to 0
5653 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0
Bram Moolenaar4d8f4762021-06-27 15:18:56 +02005654 - 'varsofttabstop' is made empty
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005655 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005656 - 'cindent'
Bram Moolenaar4d8f4762021-06-27 15:18:56 +02005657 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02005658 - 'indentexpr'
5659 - 'lisp'
Bram Moolenaar4d8f4762021-06-27 15:18:56 +02005660 - 'smartindent'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005661 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is
5662 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the
5663 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to
5664 set the 'paste' option again.
5665 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to
5666 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on.
5667 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect.
5668 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use
5669 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key.
5670
5671 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'*
5672'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "")
5673 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005674 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste'
5675 option. This is like specifying a mapping: >
5676 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR>
5677< Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'.
5678 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set.
5679 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in
5680 Command-line mode.
5681 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However,
5682 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do
5683 this: >
5684 :map <F10> :set paste<CR>
5685 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR>
5686 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR>
5687 :imap <F11> <nop>
5688 :set pastetoggle=<F11>
5689< This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode.
5690 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste
5691 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key
5692 sequence.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005693 When the value has several bytes 'ttimeoutlen' applies.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005694
5695 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'*
5696'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "")
5697 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005698 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
5699 feature}
5700 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005701 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005702
Bram Moolenaardbc28022014-07-26 13:40:44 +02005703 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E205* *E206*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005704'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "")
5705 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005706 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used
5707 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a
5708 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a
5709 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the
5710 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option
5711 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like
Bram Moolenaardf980db2017-12-24 13:22:00 +01005712 ".orig" or ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work
5713 (Detail: The backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the
5714 new file has been successfully written, that's why it must be possible
5715 to write a backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an
5716 empty file is created.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005717 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made.
5718 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the
5719 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always
5720 recognized as a compressed file.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00005721 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005722
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01005723 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347* *E854*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005724'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,,"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005725 other systems: ".,,")
5726 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005727 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00005728 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find|, |:sfind|, |:tabfind| and other commands,
5729 provided that the file being searched for has a relative path (not
5730 starting with "/", "./" or "../"). The directories in the 'path'
5731 option may be relative or absolute.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005732 - Use commas to separate directory names: >
5733 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include
5734< - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards
5735 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory
5736 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: >
5737 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space
5738< - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra
5739 backslash: >
5740 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma
5741< - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: >
5742 :set path=.
5743< - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two
5744 commas: >
5745 :set path=,,
5746< - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'.
5747 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5748 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding
5749 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work.
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00005750 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree using "*", "**" and
5751 ";". See |file-searching| for info and syntax.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005752 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature}
5753 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: >
5754 :set path=.,c:\\include
5755< Or just use '/' instead: >
5756 :set path=.,c:/include
5757< Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as
5758 the file!
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005759 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005760 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
5761 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of
5762 'path', see |:checkpath|.
5763 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
5764 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
5765 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: >
5766 :set path-=
5767< To add the current directory use: >
5768 :set path+=
5769< To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the
5770 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory
5771 names are separated with a semi-colon: >
5772 :let &path = &path . "," . substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g')
5773< Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that
5774 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space.
5775
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +02005776 *'perldll'*
5777'perldll' string (default depends on the build)
5778 global
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +02005779 {only available when compiled with the |+perl/dyn|
5780 feature}
5781 Specifies the name of the Perl shared library. The default is
5782 DYNAMIC_PERL_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
5783 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5784 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5785 security reasons.
5786
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005787 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'*
5788'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off)
5789 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005790 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the
5791 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a
5792 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is
5793 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option
5794 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible
5795 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005796 'expandtab' does not apply to the preserved white space, a Tab remains
5797 a Tab.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005798 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of
5799 tabs and spaces. You might not like this.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01005800 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005801 Also see 'copyindent'.
5802 Use |:retab| to clean up white space.
5803
5804 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'*
5805'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12)
5806 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02005807 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
5808 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005809 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated
Bram Moolenaar79648732019-07-18 21:43:07 +02005810 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given. Not used when
5811 'previewpopup' is set.
5812
5813 *'previewpopup'* *'pvp'*
5814'previewpopup' 'pvp' string (default empty)
5815 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02005816 {not available when compiled without the |+textprop|
5817 or |+quickfix| feature}
Bram Moolenaar79648732019-07-18 21:43:07 +02005818 When not empty a popup window is used for commands that would open a
5819 preview window. See |preview-popup|.
Bram Moolenaar576a4a62019-08-18 15:25:17 +02005820 Not used for the insert completion info, add "popup" to
5821 'completeopt' for that.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005822
5823 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'*
5824 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590*
5825'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off)
5826 local to window
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02005827 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
5828 feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005829 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005830 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands
5831 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc.
5832
5833 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'*
5834'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty)
5835 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005836 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5837 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005838 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|.
5839 See |pdev-option|.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00005840 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5841 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005842
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005843 *'printencoding'* *'penc'*
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02005844'printencoding' 'penc' string (default empty, except for some systems)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005845 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005846 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5847 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005848 Sets the character encoding used when printing.
5849 See |penc-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005850
5851 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'*
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02005852'printexpr' 'pexpr' string (default: see below)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005853 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005854 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5855 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005856 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|.
5857 See |pexpr-option|.
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +01005858 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5859 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005860
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005861 *'printfont'* *'pfn'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005862'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier")
5863 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005864 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5865 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005866 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|.
5867 See |pfn-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005868
5869 *'printheader'* *'pheader'*
5870'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N")
5871 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005872 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5873 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005874 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output.
5875 See |pheader-option|.
5876
5877 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'*
5878'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "")
5879 global
Bram Moolenaar4c92e752019-02-17 21:18:32 +01005880 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5881 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005882 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
5883 See |pmbcs-option|.
5884
5885 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'*
5886'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "")
5887 global
Bram Moolenaar4c92e752019-02-17 21:18:32 +01005888 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5889 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005890 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
5891 See |pmbfn-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005892
5893 *'printoptions'* *'popt'*
5894'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "")
5895 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005896 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005897 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|.
5898 See |popt-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005899
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00005900 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'*
5901'prompt' boolean (default on)
5902 global
5903 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode.
5904
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00005905 *'pumheight'* *'ph'*
5906'pumheight' 'ph' number (default 0)
5907 global
Bram Moolenaar06a89a52006-04-29 22:01:03 +00005908 Determines the maximum number of items to show in the popup menu for
5909 Insert mode completion. When zero as much space as available is used.
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00005910 |ins-completion-menu|.
5911
Bram Moolenaara8f04aa2018-02-10 15:36:55 +01005912 *'pumwidth'* *'pw'*
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01005913'pumwidth' 'pw' number (default 15)
Bram Moolenaara8f04aa2018-02-10 15:36:55 +01005914 global
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01005915 Determines the minimum width to use for the popup menu for Insert mode
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01005916 completion. |ins-completion-menu|.
Bram Moolenaara8f04aa2018-02-10 15:36:55 +01005917
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005918 *'pythondll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005919'pythondll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005920 global
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005921 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn|
5922 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005923 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x shared library. The default is
5924 DYNAMIC_PYTHON_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005925 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005926 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5927 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00005928
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01005929 *'pythonhome'*
5930'pythonhome' string (default "")
5931 global
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01005932 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn|
5933 feature}
5934 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x home directory. When 'pythonhome'
5935 and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set, PYTHON_HOME,
5936 which was specified at compile time, will be used for the Python 2.x
5937 home directory.
5938 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5939 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5940 security reasons.
5941
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01005942 *'pythonthreedll'*
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005943'pythonthreedll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01005944 global
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01005945 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn|
5946 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005947 Specifies the name of the Python 3 shared library. The default is
5948 DYNAMIC_PYTHON3_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005949 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01005950 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5951 security reasons.
5952
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01005953 *'pythonthreehome'*
5954'pythonthreehome' string (default "")
5955 global
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01005956 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn|
5957 feature}
5958 Specifies the name of the Python 3 home directory. When
5959 'pythonthreehome' and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set,
5960 PYTHON3_HOME, which was specified at compile time, will be used for
5961 the Python 3 home directory.
5962 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5963 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5964 security reasons.
5965
Bram Moolenaarf42dd3c2017-01-28 16:06:38 +01005966 *'pyxversion'* *'pyx'*
5967'pyxversion' 'pyx' number (default depends on the build)
5968 global
Bram Moolenaarf42dd3c2017-01-28 16:06:38 +01005969 {only available when compiled with the |+python| or
5970 the |+python3| feature}
5971 Specifies the python version used for pyx* functions and commands
5972 |python_x|. The default value is as follows:
5973
5974 Compiled with Default ~
5975 |+python| and |+python3| 0
5976 only |+python| 2
5977 only |+python3| 3
5978
5979 Available values are 0, 2 and 3.
5980 If 'pyxversion' is 0, it is set to 2 or 3 after the first execution of
5981 any python2/3 commands or functions. E.g. `:py` sets to 2, and `:py3`
5982 sets to 3. `:pyx` sets it to 3 if Python 3 is available, otherwise sets
5983 to 2 if Python 2 is available.
5984 See also: |has-pythonx|
5985
5986 If Vim is compiled with only |+python| or |+python3| setting
5987 'pyxversion' has no effect. The pyx* functions and commands are
5988 always the same as the compiled version.
5989
5990 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5991 security reasons.
5992
Bram Moolenaar858ba062020-05-31 23:11:59 +02005993 *'quickfixtextfunc'* *'qftf'*
5994'quickfixtextfunc' 'qftf' string (default "")
5995 global
5996 {only available when compiled with the |+quickfix|
5997 feature}
5998 This option specifies a function to be used to get the text to display
5999 in the quickfix and location list windows. This can be used to
6000 customize the information displayed in the quickfix or location window
6001 for each entry in the corresponding quickfix or location list. See
6002 |quickfix-window-function| for an explanation of how to write the
Bram Moolenaard43906d2020-07-20 21:31:32 +02006003 function and an example. The value can be the name of a function or a
6004 lambda.
Bram Moolenaar858ba062020-05-31 23:11:59 +02006005
6006 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6007 security reasons.
6008
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00006009 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'*
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00006010'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\")
6011 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00006012 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for
6013 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|.
6014 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string,
6015 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the
6016 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string.
6017
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006018 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'*
6019'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off)
6020 local to buffer
6021 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from
6022 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started
6023 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view".
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00006024 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current
6025 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02006026 When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is set for the
6027 newly edited buffer.
Bram Moolenaar369b6f52017-01-17 12:22:32 +01006028 See 'modifiable' for disallowing changes to the buffer.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006029
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006030 *'redrawtime'* *'rdt'*
6031'redrawtime' 'rdt' number (default 2000)
6032 global
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006033 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime|
6034 feature}
6035 The time in milliseconds for redrawing the display. This applies to
Bram Moolenaar15142e22018-04-30 22:19:58 +02006036 searching for patterns for 'hlsearch', |:match| highlighting and syntax
Bram Moolenaar06f1ed22017-06-18 22:41:03 +02006037 highlighting.
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006038 When redrawing takes more than this many milliseconds no further
Bram Moolenaar06f1ed22017-06-18 22:41:03 +02006039 matches will be highlighted.
6040 For syntax highlighting the time applies per window. When over the
6041 limit syntax highlighting is disabled until |CTRL-L| is used.
6042 This is used to avoid that Vim hangs when using a very complicated
6043 pattern.
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006044
Bram Moolenaar543b7ef2013-06-01 14:50:56 +02006045 *'regexpengine'* *'re'*
Bram Moolenaare6ae6222013-05-21 21:01:10 +02006046'regexpengine' 're' number (default 0)
6047 global
Bram Moolenaare6ae6222013-05-21 21:01:10 +02006048 This selects the default regexp engine. |two-engines|
6049 The possible values are:
6050 0 automatic selection
6051 1 old engine
6052 2 NFA engine
6053 Note that when using the NFA engine and the pattern contains something
6054 that is not supported the pattern will not match. This is only useful
6055 for debugging the regexp engine.
Bram Moolenaarfda37292014-11-05 14:27:36 +01006056 Using automatic selection enables Vim to switch the engine, if the
6057 default engine becomes too costly. E.g., when the NFA engine uses too
6058 many states. This should prevent Vim from hanging on a combination of
6059 a complex pattern with long text.
Bram Moolenaare6ae6222013-05-21 21:01:10 +02006060
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006061 *'relativenumber'* *'rnu'* *'norelativenumber'* *'nornu'*
6062'relativenumber' 'rnu' boolean (default off)
6063 local to window
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006064 Show the line number relative to the line with the cursor in front of
Bram Moolenaar06b5d512010-05-22 15:37:44 +02006065 each line. Relative line numbers help you use the |count| you can
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006066 precede some vertical motion commands (e.g. j k + -) with, without
6067 having to calculate it yourself. Especially useful in combination with
6068 other commands (e.g. y d c < > gq gw =).
6069 When the 'n' option is excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped
6070 line will not use the column of line numbers (this is the default when
6071 'compatible' isn't set).
6072 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
6073 number.
6074 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
6075 characters are put before the number.
Bram Moolenaar61d35bd2012-03-28 20:51:51 +02006076 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for
6077 the number.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01006078
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02006079 The number in front of the cursor line also depends on the value of
6080 'number', see |number_relativenumber| for all combinations of the two
6081 options.
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006082
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006083 *'remap'* *'noremap'*
6084'remap' boolean (default on)
6085 global
6086 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for
6087 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command.
Bram Moolenaara3227e22006-03-08 21:32:40 +00006088 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with Vim scripts, always keep
6089 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
6090 old Vi scripts.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006091
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006092 *'renderoptions'* *'rop'*
6093'renderoptions' 'rop' string (default: empty)
6094 global
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006095 {only available when compiled with GUI and DIRECTX on
6096 MS-Windows}
6097 Select a text renderer and set its options. The options depend on the
6098 renderer.
6099
6100 Syntax: >
6101 set rop=type:{renderer}(,{name}:{value})*
6102<
6103 Currently, only one optional renderer is available.
6104
6105 render behavior ~
6106 directx Vim will draw text using DirectX (DirectWrite). It makes
6107 drawn glyphs more beautiful than default GDI.
6108 It requires 'encoding' is "utf-8", and only works on
6109 MS-Windows Vista or newer version.
6110
6111 Options:
6112 name meaning type value ~
6113 gamma gamma float 1.0 - 2.2 (maybe)
6114 contrast enhancedContrast float (unknown)
6115 level clearTypeLevel float (unknown)
6116 geom pixelGeometry int 0 - 2 (see below)
6117 renmode renderingMode int 0 - 6 (see below)
6118 taamode textAntialiasMode int 0 - 3 (see below)
Bram Moolenaara338adc2018-01-31 20:51:47 +01006119 scrlines Scroll Lines int (deprecated)
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006120
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006121 See this URL for detail (except for scrlines):
6122 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368190.aspx
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006123
6124 For geom: structure of a device pixel.
6125 0 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_FLAT
6126 1 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_RGB
6127 2 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_BGR
6128
6129 See this URL for detail:
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006130 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368114.aspx
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006131
6132 For renmode: method of rendering glyphs.
6133 0 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_DEFAULT
6134 1 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_ALIASED
6135 2 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_CLASSIC
6136 3 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_NATURAL
6137 4 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL
6138 5 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL_SYMMETRIC
6139 6 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_OUTLINE
6140
6141 See this URL for detail:
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006142 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368118.aspx
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006143
6144 For taamode: antialiasing mode used for drawing text.
6145 0 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_DEFAULT
6146 1 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_CLEARTYPE
6147 2 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_GRAYSCALE
6148 3 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_ALIASED
6149
6150 See this URL for detail:
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006151 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368170.aspx
6152
Bram Moolenaara338adc2018-01-31 20:51:47 +01006153 For scrlines:
6154 This was used for optimizing scrolling behavior, however this
6155 is now deprecated. If specified, it is simply ignored.
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006156
6157 Example: >
6158 set encoding=utf-8
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006159 set gfn=Ricty_Diminished:h12
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006160 set rop=type:directx
6161<
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006162 If select a raster font (Courier, Terminal or FixedSys which
6163 have ".fon" extension in file name) to 'guifont', it will be
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006164 drawn by GDI as a fallback.
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006165
6166 NOTE: It is known that some fonts and options combination
6167 causes trouble on drawing glyphs.
6168
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006169 - 'renmode:5' and 'renmode:6' will not work with some
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006170 special made fonts (True-Type fonts which includes only
6171 bitmap glyphs).
6172 - 'taamode:3' will not work with some vector fonts.
6173
6174 NOTE: With this option, you can display colored emoji
6175 (emoticon) in Windows 8.1 or later. To display colored emoji,
6176 there are some conditions which you should notice.
6177
6178 - If your font includes non-colored emoji already, it will
6179 be used.
6180 - If your font doesn't have emoji, the system chooses an
6181 alternative symbol font. On Windows 10, "Segoe UI Emoji"
6182 will be used.
6183 - When this alternative font didn't have fixed width glyph,
6184 emoji might be rendered beyond the bounding box of drawing
6185 cell.
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006186
6187 Other render types are currently not supported.
6188
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006189 *'report'*
6190'report' number (default 2)
6191 global
6192 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of
6193 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most
6194 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0.
6195 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used
6196 instead of the number of lines.
6197
6198 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'*
6199'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on)
6200 global
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01006201 {only in MS-Windows console version}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006202 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also
6203 happens when executing external commands.
6204
6205 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te'
6206 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring:
6207 set t_ti= t_te=
6208 To enable restoring (for an xterm):
6209 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8
6210 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it)
6211
6212 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'*
6213'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off)
6214 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006215 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
6216 feature}
6217 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing
6218 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_
6219 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006220 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6221 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
6222 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006223
6224 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'*
6225'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off)
6226 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006227 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
6228 feature}
6229 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters
6230 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left.
6231 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that
6232 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic.
6233 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files
6234 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is
6235 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left
6236 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly
6237 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|.
6238
Bram Moolenaar607cc1e2010-07-18 18:47:44 +02006239 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006240'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search")
6241 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006242 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
6243 feature}
6244 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in
6245 right-to-left mode for a group of commands:
6246
6247 search "/" and "?" commands
6248
6249 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi.
6250 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect.
6251
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006252 *'rubydll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01006253'rubydll' string (default: depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006254 global
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006255 {only available when compiled with the |+ruby/dyn|
6256 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006257 Specifies the name of the Ruby shared library. The default is
6258 DYNAMIC_RUBY_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02006259 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006260 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6261 security reasons.
6262
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006263 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02006264'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006265 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006266 {not available when compiled without the
6267 |+cmdline_info| feature}
6268 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006269 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006270 text in the file is shown on the far right:
6271 Top first line is visible
6272 Bot last line is visible
6273 All first and last line are visible
6274 45% relative position in the file
6275 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006276 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006277 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006278 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty),
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006279 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat'
6280 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of
Bram Moolenaar207f0092020-08-30 17:20:20 +02006281 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multibyte character), both
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006282 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown,
6283 separated with a dash.
6284 For an empty line "0-1" is shown.
6285 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1".
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006286 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
6287 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006288 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where
6289 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|.
6290 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6291
6292 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'*
6293'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty)
6294 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006295 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
6296 feature}
6297 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler
6298 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00006299 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02006300 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
6301
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006302 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15
6303 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end.
6304 Example: >
6305 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%)
6306<
6307 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles*
6308'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default:
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01006309 Unix: "$HOME/.vim,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006310 $VIM/vimfiles,
6311 $VIMRUNTIME,
6312 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6313 $HOME/.vim/after"
6314 Amiga: "home:vimfiles,
6315 $VIM/vimfiles,
6316 $VIMRUNTIME,
6317 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6318 home:vimfiles/after"
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01006319 MS-Windows: "$HOME/vimfiles,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006320 $VIM/vimfiles,
6321 $VIMRUNTIME,
6322 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6323 $HOME/vimfiles/after"
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02006324 macOS: "$VIM:vimfiles,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006325 $VIMRUNTIME,
6326 $VIM:vimfiles:after"
Bram Moolenaarb3f74062020-02-26 16:16:53 +01006327 Haiku: "$BE_USER_SETTINGS/vim,
6328 $VIM/vimfiles,
6329 $VIMRUNTIME,
6330 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01006331 $BE_USER_SETTINGS/vim/after"
6332 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006333 $VIM/vimfiles,
6334 $VIMRUNTIME,
6335 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006336 sys$login:vimfiles/after")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006337 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006338 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime
6339 files:
6340 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype|
6341 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts|
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00006342 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006343 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme|
6344 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler|
6345 doc/ documentation |write-local-help|
6346 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin|
Bram Moolenaar8a7d6542020-01-26 15:56:19 +01006347 import/ files that are found by `:import`
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006348 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression|
6349 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap|
6350 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans|
6351 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim|
Bram Moolenaar26852122016-05-24 20:02:38 +02006352 pack/ packages |:packadd|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006353 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin|
6354 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding|
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00006355 spell/ spell checking files |spell|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006356 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile|
6357 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor|
6358
6359 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command.
6360
6361 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations:
6362 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences.
6363 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system
6364 administrator.
6365 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim.
6366 *after-directory*
6367 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is
6368 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed
6369 defaults (rarely needed)
6370 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for
6371 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults
6372 or system-wide settings (rarely needed).
6373
Bram Moolenaard0796902016-09-16 20:02:31 +02006374 More entries are added when using |packages|. If it gets very long
6375 then `:set rtp` will be truncated, use `:echo &rtp` to see the full
6376 string.
Bram Moolenaar26852122016-05-24 20:02:38 +02006377
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006378 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal
6379 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006380 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006381 wildcards.
6382 See |:runtime|.
6383 Example: >
6384 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME
6385< This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your
6386 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a
6387 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime
6388 files).
6389 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the
6390 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME
6391 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put
6392 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed
6393 runtime files.
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01006394 When Vim is started with |--clean| the home directory entries are not
6395 included.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006396 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6397 security reasons.
6398
6399 *'scroll'* *'scr'*
6400'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height)
6401 local to window
6402 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be
6403 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size
Bram Moolenaar74667062020-12-28 15:41:41 +01006404 changes. This may happen when enabling the |status-line| or
6405 'tabline' option after setting the 'scroll' option.
6406 If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006407 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window
Bram Moolenaar25c9c682019-05-05 18:13:34 +02006408 height with ":set scroll=0".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006409
6410 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'*
6411'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off)
6412 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006413 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current
6414 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have
6415 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the
6416 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'.
6417 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be
6418 interpreted.
6419 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another
6420 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows
6421 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not.
6422
Bram Moolenaarae20f342019-11-05 21:09:23 +01006423 *'scrollfocus'* *'scf'* *'noscrollfocus'* *'noscf'*
6424'scrollfocus' 'scf' boolean (default off)
6425 global
6426 {only for MS-Windows GUI}
6427 When using the scroll wheel and this option is set, the window under
6428 the mouse pointer is scrolled. With this option off the current
6429 window is scrolled.
Bram Moolenaar5ef1c6a2019-11-10 22:09:11 +01006430 Systems other than MS-Windows always behave like this option is on.
Bram Moolenaarae20f342019-11-05 21:09:23 +01006431
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006432 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'*
6433'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1)
6434 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006435 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the
6436 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E,
6437 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly.
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00006438 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the
6439 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window
6440 height.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006441 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set.
6442
6443 *'scrolloff'* *'so'*
Bram Moolenaar50ba5262016-09-22 22:33:02 +02006444'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0, set to 5 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar375e3392019-01-31 18:26:10 +01006445 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006446 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor.
6447 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If
6448 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be
6449 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or
6450 when long lines wrap).
Bram Moolenaar375e3392019-01-31 18:26:10 +01006451 After using the local value, go back the global value with one of
6452 these two: >
6453 setlocal scrolloff<
6454 setlocal scrolloff=-1
6455< For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006456 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
6457
6458 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'*
6459'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump")
6460 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006461 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00006462 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind
6463 Options.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006464 The following words are available:
6465 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
6466 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
6467 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical
6468 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first
6469 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving
6470 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may
6471 reach a position before the start or after the end of
6472 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when
6473 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll
6474 to the desired position when possible.
6475 When now making that window the current one, two
6476 things can be done with the relative offset:
6477 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is
6478 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current
6479 window. When going back to the other window, the
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00006480 new relative offset will be used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006481 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are
6482 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When
6483 going back to the other window, it still uses the
6484 same relative offset.
6485 Also see |scroll-binding|.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00006486 When 'diff' mode is active there always is vertical scroll binding,
6487 even when "ver" isn't there.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006488
6489 *'sections'* *'sect'*
6490'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh")
6491 global
6492 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of
6493 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start
6494 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh".
6495
6496 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523*
6497'secure' boolean (default off)
6498 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006499 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in
6500 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are
6501 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into
6502 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is
6503 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006504 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006505 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then.
6506 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6507 security reasons.
6508
6509 *'selection'* *'sel'*
6510'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive")
6511 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006512 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used
6513 in Visual and Select mode.
6514 Possible values:
6515 value past line inclusive ~
6516 old no yes
6517 inclusive yes yes
6518 exclusive yes no
6519 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one
6520 character past the line.
6521 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included
6522 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the
6523 selection.
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02006524 When "old" is used and 'virtualedit' allows the cursor to move past
6525 the end of line the line break still isn't included.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006526 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end
6527 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when
6528 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty.
6529
6530 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command.
6531
6532 *'selectmode'* *'slm'*
6533'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "")
6534 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006535 This is a comma separated list of words, which specifies when to start
6536 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started.
6537 Possible values:
6538 mouse when using the mouse
6539 key when using shifted special keys
6540 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V
6541 See |Select-mode|.
6542 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command.
6543
6544 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'*
6545'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds,
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01006546 help,options,tabpages,winsize,terminal")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006547 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02006548 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006549 feature}
6550 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma
6551 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring
6552 something:
6553 word save and restore ~
6554 blank empty windows
6555 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows
6556 curdir the current directory
6557 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
6558 fold options
6559 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00006560 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only
6561 String and Number types are stored.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006562 help the help window
6563 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
6564 global values for local options)
6565 options all options and mappings (also global values for local
6566 options)
Bram Moolenaard23b7142021-04-17 21:04:34 +02006567 skiprtp exclude 'runtimepath' and 'packpath' from the options
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006568 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns'
6569 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located
6570 will become the current directory (useful with
6571 projects accessed over a network from different
6572 systems)
6573 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
6574 slashes
Bram Moolenaar18144c82006-04-12 21:52:12 +00006575 tabpages all tab pages; without this only the current tab page
6576 is restored, so that you can make a session for each
6577 tab page separately
Bram Moolenaard473c8c2018-08-11 18:00:22 +02006578 terminal include terminal windows where the command can be
6579 restored
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006580 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
6581 on Windows or DOS
6582 winpos position of the whole Vim window
6583 winsize window sizes
6584
6585 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir".
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01006586 When neither "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored
6587 with absolute paths.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006588 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files
6589 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
6590 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
6591
6592 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91*
Bram Moolenaar95a9dd12019-12-19 22:12:03 +01006593'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh", Win32: "cmd.exe")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006594 global
6595 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the
6596 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash'
6597 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006598 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006599 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
6600 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01006601
Bram Moolenaar1ff14ba2019-11-02 14:09:23 +01006602 If the name of the shell contains a space, you need to enclose it in
Bram Moolenaar5ef1c6a2019-11-10 22:09:11 +01006603 quotes and escape the space. Example with quotes: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006604 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f
6605< Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006606 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006607 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01006608 name. Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006609 separators.
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01006610 Example with escaped space (Vim will do this when initializing the
6611 option from $SHELL): >
6612 :set shell=/bin/with\\\ space/sh
Bram Moolenaard473c8c2018-08-11 18:00:22 +02006613< The resulting value of 'shell' is "/bin/with\ space/sh", two
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01006614 backslashes are consumed by `:set`.
6615
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006616 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be
6617 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com"
6618 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g.,
6619 filtering).
6620 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is
6621 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: >
6622 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos
6623< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6624 security reasons.
6625
6626 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'*
Bram Moolenaar5dc62522012-02-13 00:05:22 +01006627'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c";
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006628 Win32, when 'shell' contains "powershell":
6629 "-Command", or when it does not contain "sh"
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01006630 somewhere: "/c")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006631 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006632 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g.,
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006633 "bash.exe -c ls", "powershell.exe -Command dir", or "cmd.exe /c dir".
6634 For MS-Windows, the default is set according to the value of 'shell',
6635 to reduce the need to set this option by the user.
Bram Moolenaar5302d9e2011-09-14 17:55:08 +02006636 On Unix it can have more than one flag. Each white space separated
6637 part is passed as an argument to the shell command.
6638 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006639 Also see |dos-shell| and |dos-powershell| for MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006640 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6641 security reasons.
6642
6643 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'*
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006644'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", ">%s 2>&1", "| tee", "|& tee"
6645 "2>&1| tee", or
6646 "2>&1 | Out-File -Encoding default")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006647 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006648 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
6649 feature}
6650 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006651 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006652 including spaces and backslashes.
6653 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
6654 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
6655 of this option).
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006656 For the Amiga the default is ">". For MS-Windows using powershell the
6657 default is "2>&1 | Out-File -Encoding default", otherwise the default
6658 is ">%s 2>&1". The output is directly saved in a file and not echoed
6659 to the screen.
Bram Moolenaar1c6737b2020-09-07 22:18:52 +02006660 For Unix the default is "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006661 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or
6662 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the
Bram Moolenaar96f45c02019-10-26 19:53:45 +02006663 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh", "zsh-beta",
Natanael Copa56318362021-05-06 18:46:35 +02006664 "bash", "fish", "ash" or "dash" the default becomes "2>&1| tee". This
6665 means that stderr is also included. Before using the 'shell' option a
6666 path is removed, thus "/bin/sh" uses "sh".
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006667 For Unix and MS-Windows, when the 'shell' option is "pwsh" the default
6668 becomes ">%s 2>&1" and the output is not echoed to the screen.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006669 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
6670 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
6671 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was
6672 explicitly set before.
6673 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the
6674 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg'
6675 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do
6676 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space.
6677 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ".
6678 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
6679 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
6680 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6681 security reasons.
6682
6683 *'shellquote'* *'shq'*
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006684'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: "")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006685 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006686 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
6687 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the
6688 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's
6689 probably not useful to set both options.
6690 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01006691 third-party shells on MS-Windows-like systems, such as the MKS Korn
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006692 Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". See |dos-shell|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006693 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6694 security reasons.
6695
6696 *'shellredir'* *'srr'*
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006697'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&", ">%s 2>&1", or
6698 "2>&1 | Out-File -Encoding default")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006699 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006700 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary
6701 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces
6702 and backslashes.
6703 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
6704 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
6705 of this option).
Bram Moolenaar96f45c02019-10-26 19:53:45 +02006706 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh" or
6707 "tcsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01006708 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh", "zsh-beta",
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006709 "bash", "fish", or "pwsh", the default becomes ">%s 2>&1". This means
6710 that stderr is also included. For Win32, the Unix checks are done and
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006711 additionally "cmd" is checked for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1",
6712 and "powershell" is checked for which makes the default
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006713 "2>&1 | Out-File -Encoding default" (see |dos-powershell|). Also, the
6714 same names with ".exe" appended are checked for.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006715 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
6716 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
6717 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was
6718 explicitly set before.
6719 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
6720 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
6721 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6722 security reasons.
6723
6724 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'*
6725'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off)
6726 global
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01006727 {only for MS-Windows}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006728 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006729 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of cmd.exe, pwsh.exe, or
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006730 powershell.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are
6731 changed to forward slashes by Vim.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006732 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some
6733 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening
6734 any file for best results. This might change in the future.
6735 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path
6736 separator. To test if this is so use: >
6737 if exists('+shellslash')
Bram Moolenaarac3150d2019-07-28 16:36:39 +02006738< Also see 'completeslash'.
6739
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006740 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'*
6741'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on)
6742 global
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006743 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe.
6744 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway.
Bram Moolenaar97293012011-07-18 19:40:27 +02006745 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix and MS-Windows 2K and
6746 later. You can check it with: >
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006747 :if has("filterpipe")
6748< The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file
6749 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection.
6750 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding
6751 can be detected.
6752 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|,
6753 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when
6754 'shelltemp' is off.
Bram Moolenaar269f5952016-07-15 22:54:41 +02006755 The `system()` function does not respect this option and always uses
6756 temp files.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01006757 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
6758 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006759
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006760 *'shelltype'* *'st'*
6761'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0)
6762 global
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02006763 {only for the Amiga}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006764 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work
6765 which use a shell.
6766 0 and 1: always use the shell
6767 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines
6768 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command
6769 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly.
6770
6771 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands
6772 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands
6773
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01006774 *'shellxescape'* *'sxe'*
6775'shellxescape' 'sxe' string (default: "";
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01006776 for MS-Windows: "\"&|<>()@^")
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01006777 global
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01006778 When 'shellxquote' is set to "(" then the characters listed in this
6779 option will be escaped with a '^' character. This makes it possible
6780 to execute most external commands with cmd.exe.
6781
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006782 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'*
6783'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: "";
Bram Moolenaarf66b3fc2012-02-20 22:18:30 +01006784 for Win32, when 'shell' is cmd.exe: "("
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006785 for Win32, when 'shell' is
6786 powershell.exe: "\""
Bram Moolenaarf66b3fc2012-02-20 22:18:30 +01006787 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh"
6788 somewhere: "\""
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006789 for Unix, when using system(): "\"")
6790 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006791 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
6792 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See
6793 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful
6794 to set both options.
Bram Moolenaarf66b3fc2012-02-20 22:18:30 +01006795 When the value is '(' then ')' is appended. When the value is '"('
6796 then ')"' is appended.
6797 When the value is '(' then also see 'shellxescape'.
Bram Moolenaara64ba222012-02-12 23:23:31 +01006798 This is an empty string by default on most systems, but is known to be
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006799 useful for on Win32 version, either for cmd.exe, powershell.exe, or
6800 pwsh.exe which automatically strips off the first and last quote on a
6801 command, or 3rd-party shells such as the MKS Korn Shell or bash, where
6802 it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according the value of
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006803 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the user. See
6804 |dos-shell|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006805 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6806 security reasons.
6807
6808 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'*
6809'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off)
6810 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006811 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and <
6812 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to
6813 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible).
6814 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6815
6816 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'*
6817'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8)
6818 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006819 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006820 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc.
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +02006821 When zero the 'ts' value will be used. Use the |shiftwidth()|
6822 function to get the effective shiftwidth value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006823
6824 *'shortmess'* *'shm'*
Bram Moolenaar9dfa3132019-05-04 21:08:40 +02006825'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToOS", Vi default: "S",
6826 POSIX default: "AS")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006827 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006828 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file
6829 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages.
6830 It is a list of flags:
6831 flag meaning when present ~
6832 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)"
6833 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]"
Bram Moolenaar3f40ce72020-07-05 14:10:13 +02006834 l use "999L, 888B" instead of "999 lines, 888 bytes"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006835 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]"
6836 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]"
6837 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]"
6838 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message
6839 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command
6840 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of
6841 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]".
6842 a all of the above abbreviations
6843
6844 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message
6845 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on)
6846 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message.
6847 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn").
6848 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search
Bram Moolenaara6c27c42019-05-09 19:16:22 +02006849 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages; when using the search
6850 count do not show "W" after the count message (see S below)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006851 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit
6852 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column.
6853 Ignored in Ex mode.
6854 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006855 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006856 Ignored in Ex mode.
6857 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file
6858 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file
6859 is found.
6860 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|.
Bram Moolenaarea389e92014-05-28 21:40:52 +02006861 c don't give |ins-completion-menu| messages. For example,
6862 "-- XXX completion (YYY)", "match 1 of 2", "The only match",
6863 "Pattern not found", "Back at original", etc.
Bram Moolenaar426dd022016-03-15 15:09:29 +01006864 q use "recording" instead of "recording @a"
6865 F don't give the file info when editing a file, like `:silent`
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02006866 was used for the command; note that this also affects messages
6867 from autocommands
Bram Moolenaar9dfa3132019-05-04 21:08:40 +02006868 S do not show search count message when searching, e.g.
6869 "[1/5]"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006870
6871 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers
6872 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as
6873 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you
6874 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!"
6875 Useful values:
6876 shm= No abbreviation of message.
6877 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information.
6878 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary.
6879
6880 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
6881 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
6882
6883 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'*
6884'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off)
6885 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006886 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3
6887 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this
6888 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01006889 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is useful
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006890 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos
Bram Moolenaarade0d392020-01-21 22:33:58 +01006891 or crossdos.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006892
6893 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595*
6894'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaaree857022019-11-09 23:26:40 +01006895 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02006896 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006897 feature}
6898 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01006899 values are "> " or "+++ ": >
6900 :set showbreak=>\
6901< Note the backslash to escape the trailing space. It's easier like
6902 this: >
Bram Moolenaar1a384422010-07-14 19:53:30 +02006903 :let &showbreak = '+++ '
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01006904< Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006905 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the
6906 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line).
6907 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in
6908 'highlight'.
6909 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently.
6910 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the
6911 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaaree857022019-11-09 23:26:40 +01006912 A window-local value overrules a global value. If the global value is
6913 set and you want no value in the current window use NONE: >
6914 :setlocal showbreak=NONE
6915<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006916 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02006917'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix,
6918 Vi default: off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006919 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006920 {not available when compiled without the
6921 |+cmdline_info| feature}
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00006922 Show (partial) command in the last line of the screen. Set this
6923 option off if your terminal is slow.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006924 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown:
6925 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters.
Bram Moolenaarf91787c2010-07-17 12:47:16 +02006926 If the number of bytes is different it is also displayed: "2-6"
6927 means two characters and six bytes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006928 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01006929 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters:
6930 {lines}x{columns}.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006931 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
6932 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
6933
6934 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'*
6935'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off)
6936 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006937 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the
6938 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006939 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006940 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are
6941 required (coding style permitting).
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00006942 Note that this doesn't work well together with having "longest" in
6943 'completeopt', because the completion from the search pattern may not
6944 match the typed text.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006945
6946 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'*
6947'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off)
6948 global
6949 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The
6950 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to
6951 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'.
6952 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006953 seen or not).
6954 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
6955 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006956 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character
6957 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs.
6958 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and
6959 blinking when showing the match.
6960 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show
6961 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite
6962 matches.
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00006963 Also see the matchparen plugin for highlighting the match when moving
6964 around |pi_paren.txt|.
6965 Note: Use of the short form is rated PG.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006966
6967 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'*
6968'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
6969 global
6970 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line.
6971 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for
6972 this message.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006973 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006974 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is
6975 not set.
6976 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
6977 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
6978
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00006979 *'showtabline'* *'stal'*
6980'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1)
6981 global
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00006982 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels
6983 will be displayed:
6984 0: never
6985 1: only if there are at least two tab pages
6986 2: always
6987 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages
6988 line.
6989 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages.
6990
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006991 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'*
6992'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0)
6993 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006994 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when
6995 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen.
6996 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen.
6997 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using
6998 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl"
6999 commands.
7000
7001 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'*
7002'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0)
Bram Moolenaar375e3392019-01-31 18:26:10 +01007003 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007004 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00007005 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a
7006 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero
7007 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in
7008 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option
7009 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor
7010 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too
7011 close to the beginning of the line.
Bram Moolenaar375e3392019-01-31 18:26:10 +01007012 After using the local value, go back the global value with one of
7013 these two: >
7014 setlocal sidescrolloff<
7015 setlocal sidescrolloff=-1
7016< NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007017
7018 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as
7019 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +02007020 onto the "extends" character: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007021
7022 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:<
7023 :set sidescrolloff=1
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +02007024<
7025 *'signcolumn'* *'scl'*
7026'signcolumn' 'scl' string (default "auto")
7027 local to window
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +02007028 {not available when compiled without the |+signs|
7029 feature}
Bram Moolenaar09521312016-08-12 22:54:35 +02007030 Whether or not to draw the signcolumn. Valid values are:
7031 "auto" only when there is a sign to display
7032 "no" never
7033 "yes" always
Bram Moolenaar394c5d82019-06-17 21:48:05 +02007034 "number" display signs in the 'number' column. If the number
Bram Moolenaar6c1e1572019-06-22 02:13:00 +02007035 column is not present, then behaves like "auto".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007036
7037
7038 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'*
7039'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off)
7040 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007041 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper
7042 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and
7043 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N",
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +02007044 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc. After
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007045 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command,
7046 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>.
7047 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
7048
7049 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'*
7050'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off)
7051 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007052 {not available when compiled without the
7053 |+smartindent| feature}
7054 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like
7055 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does
7056 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict,
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01007057 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on or 'indentexpr' is set,
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01007058 setting 'si' has no effect. 'indentexpr' is a more advanced
7059 alternative.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007060 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'.
7061 An indent is automatically inserted:
7062 - After a line ending in '{'.
7063 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'.
7064 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command).
7065 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is
7066 given the same indent as the matching '{'.
7067 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for
7068 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007069 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007070 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H.
7071 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted
7072 right.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01007073 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007074 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
7075 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007076
7077 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'*
7078'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off)
7079 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007080 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00007081 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A
7082 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the
7083 line.
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00007084 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00007085 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or
7086 right |shift-left-right|.
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00007087 What gets inserted (a <Tab> or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007088 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00007089 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007090 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
7091 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007092 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
7093
7094 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'*
7095'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0)
7096 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007097 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing
7098 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like
7099 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is
7100 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value
7101 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However,
7102 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters.
7103 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off.
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +02007104 When 'sts' is negative, the value of 'shiftwidth' is used.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007105 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored
7106 when 'paste' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007107 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of
7108 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
7109 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is
7110 set.
7111 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
7112
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02007113 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of
7114 'softtabstop' will be ignored if |'varsofttabstop'| is set to
7115 anything other than an empty string.
7116
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007117 *'spell'* *'nospell'*
7118'spell' boolean (default off)
7119 local to window
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007120 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7121 feature}
7122 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00007123 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'.
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007124
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007125 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'*
Bram Moolenaar0dc065e2005-07-04 22:49:24 +00007126'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+")
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007127 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007128 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7129 feature}
7130 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be
7131 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00007132 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled).
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007133 When this check is not wanted make this option empty.
7134 Only used when 'spell' is set.
Bram Moolenaar0dc065e2005-07-04 22:49:24 +00007135 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about
7136 including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007137 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see
7138 |set-spc-auto|.
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007139
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007140 *'spellfile'* *'spf'*
7141'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty)
7142 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007143 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7144 feature}
7145 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw|
Bram Moolenaar045e82d2005-07-08 22:25:33 +00007146 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the
7147 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory.
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007148 *E765*
7149 It may also be a comma separated list of names. A count before the
7150 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using
7151 a personal word list file and a project word list file.
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007152 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00007153 you: Using the first directory in 'runtimepath' that is writable. If
7154 there is no "spell" directory yet it will be created. For the file
7155 name the first language name that appears in 'spelllang' is used,
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007156 ignoring the region.
7157 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not
7158 have to appear in 'spelllang'.
7159 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region
7160 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when
7161 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files
7162 without region name will be found.
Bram Moolenaare7566042005-06-17 22:00:15 +00007163 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7164 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007165
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007166 *'spelllang'* *'spl'*
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007167'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en")
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007168 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007169 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7170 feature}
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007171 A comma separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is
7172 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: >
7173 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical
7174< This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words
7175 that are not recognized will be highlighted.
Bram Moolenaar911ead12019-04-21 00:03:35 +02007176 The word list name must consist of alphanumeric characters, a dash or
7177 an underscore. It should not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007178 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a
7179 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words.
7180 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is
7181 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one
7182 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian
7183 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01007184 Britain. (Note: currently en_au and en_nz dictionaries are older than
7185 en_ca, en_gb and en_us).
Bram Moolenaarcc63c642013-11-12 04:44:01 +01007186 If the name "cjk" is included East Asian characters are excluded from
7187 spell checking. This is useful when editing text that also has Asian
7188 words.
Bram Moolenaar6c391a72021-09-09 21:55:11 +02007189 Note that the "medical" dictionary does not exist, it is just an
7190 example of a longer name.
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00007191 *E757*
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00007192 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The
7193 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name
7194 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter).
7195 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct
7196 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00007197 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00007198 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the
7199 files twice.
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007200 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|.
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007201
Bram Moolenaar98692072006-02-04 00:57:42 +00007202 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name
7203 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin
7204 will ask you if you want to download the file.
7205
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007206 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files
7207 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang'
Bram Moolenaarb730f0c2018-11-25 03:56:26 +01007208 up to the first character that is not an ASCII letter or number and
7209 not a dash. Also see |set-spc-auto|.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007210
Bram Moolenaar362b44b2020-06-10 21:47:00 +02007211 *'spelloptions'* *'spo'*
7212'spelloptions' 'spo' string (default "")
7213 local to buffer
7214 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7215 feature}
7216 A comma separated list of options for spell checking:
7217 camel When a word is CamelCased, assume "Cased" is a
7218 separate word: every upper-case character in a word
7219 that comes after a lower case character indicates the
7220 start of a new word.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007221
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007222 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'*
7223'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best")
7224 global
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007225 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7226 feature}
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00007227 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007228 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of
7229 items:
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007230
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007231 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds
7232 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like
7233 scoring to improve the ordering.
7234
7235 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the
7236 results. The first method is "fast", the other method
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007237 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007238 word. That only works when the language specifies
7239 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give
7240 better results.
7241
7242 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes:
7243 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for
7244 simple typing mistakes.
7245
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00007246 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|.
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00007247 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of
7248 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines'
7249 minus two.
7250
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007251 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns,
7252 separated by a slash. The first column contains the
7253 bad word, the second column the suggested good word.
7254 Example:
7255 theribal/terrible ~
7256 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the
7257 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods.
7258 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for
7259 comments.
Bram Moolenaarbcb98982014-05-01 14:08:19 +02007260 The word in the second column must be correct,
7261 otherwise it will not be used. Add the word to an
7262 ".add" file if it is currently flagged as a spelling
7263 mistake.
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007264 The file is used for all languages.
7265
7266 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid
7267 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled
7268 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of
7269 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score.
7270 Example:
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01007271 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]] ~
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00007272 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007273 internal methods use. A lower score is better.
7274 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily
7275 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part.
7276 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the
7277 'verbose' option to a non-zero value.
7278
7279 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may
7280 appear several times in any order. Example: >
7281 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest()
7282<
7283 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7284 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007285
7286
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007287 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'*
7288'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off)
7289 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007290 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current
7291 one. |:split|
7292
7293 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'*
7294'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off)
7295 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007296 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the
7297 current one. |:vsplit|
7298
7299 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'*
7300'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on)
7301 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007302 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00007303 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007304 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B,
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00007305 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007306 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing
7307 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that
7308 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+".
7309 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column
7310 where it was the last time the buffer was edited.
7311 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
7312
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01007313 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E542*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007314'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty)
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00007315 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007316 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
7317 feature}
7318 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the status line.
7319 Also see |status-line|.
7320
7321 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with
7322 normal text. Each status line item is of the form:
7323 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item}
Bram Moolenaar5e9b2fa2016-02-01 22:37:05 +01007324 All fields except the {item} are optional. A single percent sign can
Bram Moolenaar8133cc62020-10-26 21:05:27 +01007325 be given as "%%".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007326
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007327 When the option starts with "%!" then it is used as an expression,
7328 evaluated and the result is used as the option value. Example: >
7329 :set statusline=%!MyStatusLine()
Bram Moolenaar1c6fd1e2019-05-23 22:11:59 +02007330< The *g:statusline_winid* variable will be set to the |window-ID| of the
7331 window that the status line belongs to.
7332 The result can contain %{} items that will be evaluated too.
Bram Moolenaar61d35bd2012-03-28 20:51:51 +02007333 Note that the "%!" expression is evaluated in the context of the
7334 current window and buffer, while %{} items are evaluated in the
7335 context of the window that the statusline belongs to.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007336
7337 When there is error while evaluating the option then it will be made
7338 empty to avoid further errors. Otherwise screen updating would loop.
7339
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007340 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and
7341 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|.
7342
7343 field meaning ~
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007344 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007345 when minwid is larger than the length of the item.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007346 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007347 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'.
7348 Value must be 50 or less.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007349 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007350 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be
7351 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number
7352 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like
7353 an exponential notation.
7354 item A one letter code as described below.
7355
7356 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The
7357 second character in "item" is the type:
7358 N for number
7359 S for string
7360 F for flags as described below
7361 - not applicable
7362
7363 item meaning ~
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00007364 f S Path to the file in the buffer, as typed or relative to current
7365 directory.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007366 F S Full path to the file in the buffer.
7367 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer.
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007368 m F Modified flag, text is "[+]"; "[-]" if 'modifiable' is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007369 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007370 r F Readonly flag, text is "[RO]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007371 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007372 h F Help buffer flag, text is "[help]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007373 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007374 w F Preview window flag, text is "[Preview]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007375 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007376 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., "[vim]". See 'filetype'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007377 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'.
Bram Moolenaar7fd73202010-07-25 16:58:46 +02007378 q S "[Quickfix List]", "[Location List]" or empty.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007379 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are
7380 being used: "<keymap>"
7381 n N Buffer number.
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01007382 b N Value of character under cursor.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007383 B N As above, in hexadecimal.
7384 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1.
7385 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added)
7386 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature}
7387 O N As above, in hexadecimal.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007388 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007389 l N Line number.
7390 L N Number of lines in buffer.
Bram Moolenaar1d59aa12020-09-19 18:50:13 +02007391 c N Column number (byte index).
7392 v N Virtual column number (screen column).
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007393 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007394 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|.
7395 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +02007396 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length, unless
7397 translated.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007398 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max})
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007399 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007400 { NF Evaluate expression between '%{' and '}' and substitute result.
Bram Moolenaar6d150f72018-04-21 20:03:20 +02007401 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'. The
7402 expression cannot contain a '}' character, call a function to
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01007403 work around that. See |stl-%{| below.
shadmansaleh30e3de22021-05-15 17:23:28 +02007404 {% - This is almost same as { except the result of the expression is
7405 re-evaluated as a statusline format string. Thus if the
7406 return value of expr contains % items they will get expanded.
7407 The expression can contain the } character, the end of
7408 expression is denoted by %}.
Bram Moolenaar22863042021-10-16 15:23:36 +01007409 For example: >
shadmansaleh30e3de22021-05-15 17:23:28 +02007410 func! Stl_filename() abort
7411 return "%t"
7412 endfunc
7413< `stl=%{Stl_filename()}` results in `"%t"`
7414 `stl=%{%Stl_filename()%}` results in `"Name of current file"`
Bram Moolenaar22863042021-10-16 15:23:36 +01007415 %} - End of `{%` expression
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007416 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and
7417 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere.
7418 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed.
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00007419 T N For 'tabline': start of tab page N label. Use %T after the last
7420 label. This information is used for mouse clicks.
7421 X N For 'tabline': start of close tab N label. Use %X after the
7422 label, e.g.: %3Xclose%X. Use %999X for a "close current tab"
7423 mark. This information is used for mouse clicks.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007424 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start.
7425 No width fields allowed.
7426 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items.
7427 No width fields allowed.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007428 # - Set highlight group. The name must follow and then a # again.
7429 Thus use %#HLname# for highlight group HLname. The same
7430 highlighting is used, also for the statusline of non-current
7431 windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007432 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007433 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007434 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied
7435 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows.
7436 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9|
7437
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007438 When displaying a flag, Vim removes the leading comma, if any, when
7439 that flag comes right after plaintext. This will make a nice display
7440 when flags are used like in the examples below.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007441
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007442 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007443 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will
7444 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear
7445 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. >
7446 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)...
Bram Moolenaar1c6fd1e2019-05-23 22:11:59 +02007447< Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status
7448 line is displayed.
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01007449 *stl-%{* *g:actual_curbuf* *g:actual_curwin*
Bram Moolenaarade0d392020-01-21 22:33:58 +01007450 While evaluating %{} the current buffer and current window will be set
7451 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01007452 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context.
7453 The variable "g:actual_curbuf" is set to the `bufnr()` number of the
7454 real current buffer and "g:actual_curwin" to the |window-ID| of the
7455 real current window. These values are strings.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00007456
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02007457 The 'statusline' option will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from
7458 a modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02007459 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00007460
7461 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
7462 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007463
7464 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting
7465 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by
7466 setting an option without changing its value. Example: >
7467 :let &ro = &ro
7468
7469< A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes.
7470 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules
7471 described above.
7472
Bram Moolenaarcd71fa32005-03-11 22:46:48 +00007473 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007474 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02007475 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim --clean" to get it right.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007476
7477 Examples:
7478 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set >
7479 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P
7480< Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") >
7481 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P
7482< Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. >
7483 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b'
7484 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red
7485< Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded >
7486 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h...
7487< In the |:autocmd|'s: >
7488 :let b:gzflag = 1
7489< And: >
7490 :unlet b:gzflag
7491< And define this function: >
7492 :function VarExists(var, val)
7493 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif
7494 :endfunction
7495<
7496 *'suffixes'* *'su'*
7497'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj")
7498 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007499 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files
7500 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007501 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as
7502 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007503 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about
7504 including spaces and backslashes).
7505 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files.
7506 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
7507 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
7508 uses another default.
7509
7510 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'*
7511'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "")
7512 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007513 {not available when compiled without the
7514 |+file_in_path| feature}
7515 Comma separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a
7516 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: >
7517 :set suffixesadd=.java
7518<
7519 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'*
7520'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on)
7521 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007522 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007523 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with
7524 confidential information that even root must not be able to access.
7525 Careful: All text will be in memory:
7526 - Don't use this for big files.
7527 - Recovery will be impossible!
7528 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and
7529 'swapfile' is set.
7530 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is
7531 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is
7532 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created.
7533 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|.
Bram Moolenaar76f3b1a2014-03-27 22:30:07 +01007534 If you want to open a new buffer without creating a swap file for it,
7535 use the |:noswapfile| modifier.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01007536 See 'directory' for where the swap file is created.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007537
7538 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to
7539 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
7540
7541 *'swapsync'* *'sws'*
7542'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync")
7543 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007544 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007545 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007546 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and
7547 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work.
7548 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it,
7549 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some
7550 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system
7551 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default
7552 fsync(), which may work better on some systems.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00007553 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007554
7555 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'*
7556'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "")
7557 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007558 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers.
Bram Moolenaard2ea7cf2021-05-30 20:54:13 +02007559 Mostly for |quickfix| commands some values are also used for other
7560 commands, as mentioned below.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007561 Possible values (comma separated list):
7562 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that
7563 contains the specified buffer (if there is one).
7564 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows.
7565 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when
7566 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is
7567 also used in all buffer related split commands, for
7568 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind".
Bram Moolenaar779b74b2006-04-10 14:55:34 +00007569 usetab Like "useopen", but also consider windows in other tab
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00007570 pages.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007571 split If included, split the current window before loading
Bram Moolenaar15146672011-10-20 22:22:38 +02007572 a buffer for a |quickfix| command that display errors.
Bram Moolenaar63b74a82019-03-24 15:09:13 +01007573 Otherwise: do not split, use current window (when used
7574 in the quickfix window: the previously used window or
7575 split if there is no other window).
Bram Moolenaara594d772015-06-19 14:41:49 +02007576 vsplit Just like "split" but split vertically.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007577 newtab Like "split", but open a new tab page. Overrules
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02007578 "split" when both are present.
Bram Moolenaar539aa6b2019-11-17 18:09:38 +01007579 uselast If included, jump to the previously used window when
7580 jumping to errors with |quickfix| commands.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007581
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00007582 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'*
7583'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000)
7584 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00007585 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7586 feature}
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00007587 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the
7588 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not
7589 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared.
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00007590 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one
7591 long line.
7592 Set to zero to remove the limit.
7593
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007594 *'syntax'* *'syn'*
7595'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty)
7596 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007597 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7598 feature}
7599 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless
7600 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off".
7601 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the
7602 b:current_syntax variable does).
7603 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00007604 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file:
7605 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */ ~
7606 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
7607 names. Example:
7608 /* vim: set syntax=c.doxygen : */ ~
7609 This will use the "c" syntax first, then the "doxygen" syntax.
7610 Note that the second one must be prepared to be loaded as an addition,
7611 otherwise it will be skipped. More than one dot may appear.
7612 To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007613 :set syntax=OFF
7614< To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the
7615 'filetype' option: >
7616 :set syntax=ON
7617< What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the
7618 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument.
7619 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
7620 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00007621 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007622
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007623 *'tabline'* *'tal'*
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007624'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty)
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00007625 global
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007626 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the tab pages
7627 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00007628 tab pages line. See |setting-tabline| for more info.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007629
7630 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline'
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00007631 option and only when there is no GUI tab line. When 'e' is in
7632 'guioptions' and the GUI supports a tab line 'guitablabel' is used
Bram Moolenaar7f036442010-08-15 15:24:20 +02007633 instead. Note that the two tab pages lines are very different.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007634
7635 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use
7636 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00007637 the text to be displayed. Use "%1T" for the first label, "%2T" for
7638 the second one, etc. Use "%X" items for closing labels.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007639
Bram Moolenaare12bab32019-01-08 22:02:56 +01007640 When changing something that is used in 'tabline' that does not
7641 trigger it to be updated, use |:redrawtabline|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02007642 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaare12bab32019-01-08 22:02:56 +01007643
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007644 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others
7645 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows.
7646
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00007647
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007648 *'tabpagemax'* *'tpm'*
7649'tabpagemax' 'tpm' number (default 10)
7650 global
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007651 Maximum number of tab pages to be opened by the |-p| command line
7652 argument or the ":tab all" command. |tabpage|
7653
7654
7655 *'tabstop'* *'ts'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007656'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8)
7657 local to buffer
7658 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see
7659 |:retab| command, and 'softtabstop' option.
7660
7661 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file
7662 appear wrong in many places (e.g., when printing it).
7663
7664 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim:
7665 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4
7666 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00007667 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing <Tab> and <BS> will
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007668 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters.
7669 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use
7670 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The
7671 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed.
7672 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007673 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007674 works when using Vim to edit the file.
7675 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and
7676 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only)
7677 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have
7678 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this
7679 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is
7680 changed.
7681
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02007682 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of
7683 'tabstop' will be ignored if |'vartabstop'| is set to anything other
7684 than an empty string.
7685
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007686 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'*
7687'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on)
7688 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007689 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007690 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007691 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search
7692 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted.
7693 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that
7694 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the
7695 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off.
7696
7697 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007698 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007699 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When
7700 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done.
7701
7702 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line
7703 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: >
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007704 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some comment/
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007705< [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>]
7706
7707 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007708 files listed in 'tags', and case is ignored or a pattern is used
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007709 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search.
7710 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only
7711 be found in the retry.
7712
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +00007713 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second,
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007714 linear search can be avoided when case is ignored. Use a value of '2'
7715 in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be case-fold
7716 sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in the command:
7717 "sort -f -o tags tags". For "Exuberant ctags" version 5.x or higher
7718 (at least 5.5) the --sort=foldcase switch can be used for this as
7719 well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for this to work.
7720
7721 By default, tag searches are case-sensitive. Case is ignored when
7722 'ignorecase' is set and 'tagcase' is "followic", or when 'tagcase' is
7723 "ignore".
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02007724 Also when 'tagcase' is "followscs" and 'smartcase' is set, or
7725 'tagcase' is "smart", and the pattern contains only lowercase
7726 characters.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007727
7728 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match
7729 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags
7730 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off.
7731 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on
7732 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above
7733 must be included in the tags file.
7734 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g.,
7735 command-line completion and ":help").
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007736
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007737 *'tagcase'* *'tc'*
7738'tagcase' 'tc' string (default "followic")
7739 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007740 This option specifies how case is handled when searching the tags
7741 file:
7742 followic Follow the 'ignorecase' option
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02007743 followscs Follow the 'smartcase' and 'ignorecase' options
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007744 ignore Ignore case
7745 match Match case
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02007746 smart Ignore case unless an upper case letter is used
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01007747 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7748 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007749
Bram Moolenaar45e18cb2019-04-28 18:05:35 +02007750 *'tagfunc'* *'tfu'*
7751'tagfunc' 'tfu' string (default: empty)
7752 local to buffer
7753 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
7754 feature}
7755 This option specifies a function to be used to perform tag searches.
7756 The function gets the tag pattern and should return a List of matching
7757 tags. See |tag-function| for an explanation of how to write the
7758 function and an example.
7759
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007760 *'taglength'* *'tl'*
7761'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0)
7762 global
7763 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters.
7764
7765 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'*
7766'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
7767 global
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00007768 If on and using a tags file in another directory, file names in that
7769 tags file are relative to the directory where the tags file is.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007770 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7771 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7772
7773 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433*
7774'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with
7775 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS")
7776 global or local to buffer |global-local|
7777 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To
7778 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash
7779 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes).
7780 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path
7781 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in
7782 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see
7783 |tags-option|.
7784 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in
Bram Moolenaare2b590e2010-08-08 18:29:48 +02007785 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. E.g., "/lib/**/tags" will
7786 find all files named "tags" below "/lib". The filename itself cannot
7787 contain wildcards, it is used as-is. E.g., "/lib/**/tags?" will find
7788 files called "tags?". {not available when compiled without the
7789 |+path_extra| feature}
Bram Moolenaare7eb9df2005-09-09 19:49:30 +00007790 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names
7791 actually used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007792 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag
7793 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The
7794 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case
7795 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags|
7796 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
7797 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
7798 uses another default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007799
7800 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'*
7801'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on)
7802 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007803 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or
7804 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the
7805 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or
7806 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified
7807 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry.
7808 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a
7809 mapping which should not change the tagstack.
7810
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007811 *'tcldll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01007812'tcldll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007813 global
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007814 {only available when compiled with the |+tcl/dyn|
7815 feature}
7816 Specifies the name of the Tcl shared library. The default is
7817 DYNAMIC_TCL_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02007818 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007819 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7820 security reasons.
7821
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007822 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531*
7823'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails:
7824 in the GUI: "builtin_gui"
7825 on Amiga: "amiga"
Bram Moolenaarb3f74062020-02-26 16:16:53 +01007826 on Haiku: "xterm"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007827 on Mac: "mac-ansi"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007828 on Unix: "ansi"
7829 on VMS: "ansi"
7830 on Win 32: "win32")
7831 global
7832 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control
7833 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
7834 For example: >
7835 :set term=$TERM
7836< See |termcap|.
7837
7838 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'*
7839 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'*
7840'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm")
7841 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007842 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
7843 feature}
7844 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified
7845 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping
7846 that some languages (such as Arabic) require.
7847 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when
7848 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored.
7849 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that
7850 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically.
7851 This option is reset when the GUI is started.
7852 For further details see |arabic.txt|.
7853
7854 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'*
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02007855'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ GUI: "utf-8")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007856 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007857 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character
7858 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01007859 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ('encoding' is used for the
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02007860 display).
Bram Moolenaar4b7cdca2020-01-01 16:18:38 +01007861 *E617* *E950*
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01007862 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ GUI. After the GUI has been
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007863 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8".
7864 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error
7865 message is shown.
Bram Moolenaarac360bf2015-09-01 20:31:20 +02007866 For the Win32 GUI and console versions 'termencoding' is not used,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007867 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters.
7868 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option.
7869 This is the normal value.
7870 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See
7871 |encoding-table|.
7872 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or
7873 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you
7874 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters.
7875 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and
7876 want to edit a UTF-8 file: >
7877 :let &termencoding = &encoding
7878 :set encoding=utf-8
7879< You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8.
7880
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01007881 *'termguicolors'* *'tgc'* *E954*
Bram Moolenaar61be73b2016-04-29 22:59:22 +02007882'termguicolors' 'tgc' boolean (default off)
7883 global
Bram Moolenaar61be73b2016-04-29 22:59:22 +02007884 {not available when compiled without the
7885 |+termguicolors| feature}
7886 When on, uses |highlight-guifg| and |highlight-guibg| attributes in
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01007887 the terminal (thus using 24-bit color).
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01007888
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01007889 Requires a ISO-8613-3 compatible terminal. If setting this option
7890 does not work (produces a colorless UI) reading |xterm-true-color|
7891 might help.
7892
7893 For Win32 console, Windows 10 version 1703 (Creators Update) or later
7894 is required. Use this check to find out: >
7895 if has('vcon')
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01007896< This requires Vim to be built with the |+vtp| feature.
7897
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +02007898 Note that the "cterm" attributes are still used, not the "gui" ones.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01007899 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar61be73b2016-04-29 22:59:22 +02007900
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02007901 *'termwinkey'* *'twk'*
7902'termwinkey' 'twk' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02007903 local to window
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02007904 The key that starts a CTRL-W command in a terminal window. Other keys
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02007905 are sent to the job running in the window.
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02007906 The <> notation can be used, e.g.: >
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02007907 :set termwinkey=<C-L>
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02007908< The string must be one key stroke but can be multiple bytes.
7909 When not set CTRL-W is used, so that CTRL-W : gets you to the command
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02007910 line. If 'termwinkey' is set to CTRL-L then CTRL-L : gets you to the
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02007911 command line.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02007912
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02007913 *'termwinscroll'* *'twsl'*
7914'termwinscroll' 'twsl' number (default 10000)
7915 local to buffer
7916 {not available when compiled without the
7917 |+terminal| feature}
7918 Number of scrollback lines to keep. When going over this limit the
7919 first 10% of the scrollback lines are deleted. This is just to reduce
7920 the memory usage. See |Terminal-Normal|.
7921
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02007922 *'termwinsize'* *'tws'*
7923'termwinsize' 'tws' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02007924 local to window
Bram Moolenaar1c6737b2020-09-07 22:18:52 +02007925 Size used when opening the |terminal| window. Format:
7926 {rows}x{columns} or {rows}*{columns}.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02007927 - When empty the terminal gets the size from the window.
Bram Moolenaar498c2562018-04-15 23:45:15 +02007928 - When set with a "x" (e.g., "24x80") the terminal size is not
7929 adjusted to the window size. If the window is smaller only the
7930 top-left part is displayed.
7931 - When set with a "*" (e.g., "10*50") the terminal size follows the
7932 window size, but will not be smaller than the specified rows and/or
7933 columns.
7934 - When rows is zero then use the height of the window.
7935 - When columns is zero then use the width of the window.
7936 - Using "0x0" or "0*0" is the same as empty.
Bram Moolenaar1c6737b2020-09-07 22:18:52 +02007937 - Can be overruled in the |term_start()| options with "term_rows" and
7938 "term_cols".
Bram Moolenaar498c2562018-04-15 23:45:15 +02007939
7940 Examples:
7941 "30x0" uses 30 rows and the current window width.
7942 "20*0" uses at least 20 rows and the current window width.
7943 "0*40" uses the current window height and at least 40 columns.
Bram Moolenaar1f2903c2017-07-23 19:51:01 +02007944 Note that the command running in the terminal window may still change
7945 the size of the terminal. In that case the Vim window will be
7946 adjusted to that size, if possible.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02007947
Bram Moolenaarc6ddce32019-02-08 12:47:03 +01007948 *'termwintype'* *'twt'*
7949'termwintype' 'twt' string (default "")
7950 global
Bram Moolenaarc6ddce32019-02-08 12:47:03 +01007951 {only available when compiled with the |terminal|
7952 feature on MS-Windows}
7953 Specify the virtual console (pty) used when opening the terminal
7954 window.
7955
7956 Possible values are:
Bram Moolenaard9ef1b82019-02-13 19:23:10 +01007957 "" use ConPTY if it is stable, winpty otherwise
Bram Moolenaarc6ddce32019-02-08 12:47:03 +01007958 "winpty" use winpty, fail if not supported
7959 "conpty" use |ConPTY|, fail if not supported
7960
Bram Moolenaard9ef1b82019-02-13 19:23:10 +01007961 |ConPTY| support depends on the platform. Windows 10 October 2018
7962 Update is the first version that supports ConPTY, however it is still
7963 considered unstable. ConPTY might become stable in the next release
7964 of Windows 10. winpty support needs to be installed. If neither is
Bram Moolenaarc6ddce32019-02-08 12:47:03 +01007965 supported then you cannot open a terminal window.
7966
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007967 *'terse'* *'noterse'*
7968'terse' boolean (default off)
7969 global
7970 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message
7971 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being
7972 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi
7973 shortens a lot of messages}
7974
7975 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'*
7976'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
7977 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007978 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'.
7979 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is
7980 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is
7981 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty.
7982 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7983 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7984
7985 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01007986'textmode' 'tx' boolean (Win32: default on,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007987 others: default off)
7988 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007989 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'.
7990 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is
7991 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to
7992 "unix".
7993
7994 *'textwidth'* *'tw'*
7995'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0)
7996 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007997 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be
7998 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007999 this.
8000 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored
8001 when 'paste' is reset.
8002 When 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008003 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
Bram Moolenaarfc1421e2006-04-20 22:17:20 +00008004 When 'formatexpr' is set it will be used to break the line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008005 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
8006
8007 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'*
8008'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "")
8009 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008010 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
Bram Moolenaarf0d58ef2018-11-16 16:13:44 +01008011 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|.
8012
8013 Each line in the file should contain words with similar meaning,
8014 separated by non-keyword characters (white space is preferred).
8015 Maximum line length is 510 bytes.
8016
Bram Moolenaard47d5222018-12-09 20:43:55 +01008017 An English word list was added to this github issue:
8018 https://github.com/vim/vim/issues/629#issuecomment-443293282
8019 Unpack thesaurus_pkg.zip, put the thesaurus.txt file somewhere, e.g.
8020 ~/.vim/thesaurus/english.txt, and the 'thesaurus' option to this file
8021 name.
Bram Moolenaarf0d58ef2018-11-16 16:13:44 +01008022
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008023 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008024 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
8025 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
8026 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
8027 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
8028 uses another default.
8029 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
8030
8031 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'*
8032'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off)
8033 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008034 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator.
8035 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
8036
8037 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'*
8038'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on)
8039 global
8040 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'*
Bram Moolenaar94237492017-04-23 18:40:21 +02008041'ttimeout' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008042 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008043 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a
8044 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received:
8045
8046 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~
8047 off off do not time out
8048 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes
8049 off on time out on key codes
8050
8051 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete
8052 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there
8053 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For
8054 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next
8055 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'.
8056 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for
8057 the next character to arrive. After that the already received
8058 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can
8059 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option.
8060 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause
8061 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits
8062 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start
8063 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have
8064 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key
8065 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and
8066 reset the 'timeout' option.
8067
8068 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
8069
8070 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'*
8071'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000)
8072 global
Bram Moolenaar25c9c682019-05-05 18:13:34 +02008073
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008074 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'*
Bram Moolenaar94237492017-04-23 18:40:21 +02008075'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1, set to 100 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008076 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008077 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key
8078 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G
8079 when part of a command has been typed.
8080 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a
8081 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to
8082 a non-negative number.
8083
8084 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~
8085 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen'
8086 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen'
8087
8088 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options
8089 tell so. A useful setting would be >
8090 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100
8091< (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after
8092 a tenth of a second).
8093
8094 *'title'* *'notitle'*
8095'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
8096 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008097 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
8098 feature}
8099 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of
8100 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to:
8101 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM
8102 Where:
8103 filename the name of the file being edited
8104 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off
8105 + indicates the file was modified
8106 = indicates the file is read-only
8107 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified
8108 (path) is the path of the file being edited
8109 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM"
8110 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles
8111 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and
Bram Moolenaard1caa942020-04-10 22:10:56 +02008112 terminals with a non-empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008113 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap).
8114 *X11*
8115 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
8116 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11"
8117 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also
8118 works for the icon name |'icon'|.
8119 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title
8120 will not work (except in the GUI).
8121 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'.
8122 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then.
8123 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command:
8124 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY &
8125 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the
8126 title of the window should change back to what it should be after
8127 exiting Vim.
8128
8129 *'titlelen'*
8130'titlelen' number (default 85)
8131 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008132 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
8133 feature}
8134 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008135 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is
8136 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008137 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But
8138 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters
8139 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title
8140 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise,
8141 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used.
8142 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option.
8143
8144 *'titleold'*
8145'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim")
8146 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008147 {only available when compiled with the |+title|
8148 feature}
8149 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the
8150 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or
8151 'titlestring' is not empty.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00008152 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8153 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008154 *'titlestring'*
8155'titlestring' string (default "")
8156 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008157 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
8158 feature}
8159 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the
8160 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on.
8161 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently
8162 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a
8163 non-empty 't_ts' option).
8164 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +01008165 be restored if possible, see |X11|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02008166
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008167 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
8168 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02008169 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
8170
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008171 Example: >
8172 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() . "/" . expand("%:p")
8173 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70
8174< The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right
8175 of the available space.
8176 Some people prefer to have the file name first: >
8177 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%)
8178< Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008179 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008180 separating space only when needed.
8181 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display
8182 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character).
8183 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
8184
8185 *'toolbar'* *'tb'*
8186'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips")
8187 global
8188 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Athena|, |+GUI_Motif| and
8189 |+GUI_Photon|}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008190 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008191 possible values are:
8192 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons.
8193 text Toolbar buttons shown with text.
8194 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008195 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008196 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons.
8197 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse
8198 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment.
8199
8200 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the
8201 following: >
8202 :set tb=icons,text
8203< Motif and Athena cannot display icons and text at the same time. They
8204 will show icons if both are requested.
8205
8206 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if
8207 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable
8208 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: >
8209 :set guioptions-=T
8210< Also see |gui-toolbar|.
8211
8212 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'*
8213'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small")
8214 global
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01008215 {only in the GTK+ GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008216 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are:
Bram Moolenaar77cdfd12016-03-12 12:57:59 +01008217 tiny Use tiny icons.
8218 small Use small icons (default).
8219 medium Use medium-sized icons.
8220 large Use large icons.
8221 huge Use even larger icons.
8222 giant Use very big icons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008223 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on
Bram Moolenaar77cdfd12016-03-12 12:57:59 +01008224 the current theme. Common dimensions are giant=48x48, huge=32x32,
8225 large=24x24, medium=24x24, small=20x20 and tiny=16x16.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008226
8227 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined
8228 by user preferences or the current theme is used.
8229
8230 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'*
8231'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on)
8232 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008233 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones.
8234 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones.
8235 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for
8236 the change to take effect, for example: >
8237 :set notbi term=$TERM
8238< See also |termcap|.
8239 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin
8240 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty
8241 xterm entries...).
8242
8243 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'*
8244'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm,
8245 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or
8246 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in
8247 a DOS console)
8248 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008249 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to
8250 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line
8251 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple
8252 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region.
8253 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen
8254 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the
8255 mouse in an xterm and other terminals.
8256
8257 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'*
8258'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term')
8259 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008260 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not
8261 available when compiled without |+mouse|}
8262 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized.
Bram Moolenaar2c7a7632007-05-10 18:19:11 +00008263 Currently these strings are valid:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008264 *xterm-mouse*
8265 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates
8266 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes:
8267 "s" = button state
8268 "c" = column plus 33
8269 "r" = row plus 33
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008270 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec",
8271 "urxvt", and "sgr" for solutions.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008272 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the
8273 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works
8274 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00008275 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008276 work. See below for how Vim detects this
8277 automatically.
8278 *netterm-mouse*
Bram Moolenaar25c9c682019-05-05 18:13:34 +02008279 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. A left mouse click generates
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008280 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers
Bram Moolenaar25c9c682019-05-05 18:13:34 +02008281 for the row and column. No other mouse events are
8282 supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008283 *dec-mouse*
8284 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a
8285 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[".
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00008286 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was
8287 configured with "--enable-dec-locator".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008288 *jsbterm-mouse*
8289 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling.
8290 *pterm-mouse*
8291 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008292 *urxvt-mouse*
8293 urxvt Mouse handling for the urxvt (rxvt-unicode) terminal.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008294 The mouse works only if the terminal supports this
8295 encoding style, but it does not have 223 columns limit
8296 unlike "xterm" or "xterm2".
Bram Moolenaar9b451252012-08-15 17:43:31 +02008297 *sgr-mouse*
8298 sgr Mouse handling for the terminal that emits SGR-styled
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008299 mouse reporting. The mouse works even in columns
8300 beyond 223. This option is backward compatible with
8301 "xterm2" because it can also decode "xterm2" style
8302 mouse codes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008303
8304 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm|
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008305 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm| |+mouse_jsbterm| |+mouse_urxvt|
8306 |+mouse_sgr|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008307 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always
8308 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes
8309 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008310 "xterm", "xterm2", "urxvt" or "sgr" (because dec mouse codes conflict
8311 with them).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008312 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is
Bram Moolenaar45758762016-10-12 23:08:06 +02008313 set to a name that starts with "xterm", "mlterm", "screen", "tmux",
8314 "st" (full match only), "st-" or "stterm", and 'ttymouse' is not set
8315 already.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008316 Additionally, if vim is compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and
8317 |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the xterm version
Bram Moolenaarf8a07122019-07-01 22:06:07 +02008318 number, more intelligent detection is done.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008319 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be
Bram Moolenaard47d5222018-12-09 20:43:55 +01008320 from 95 to 276. The "sgr" value will be set if Vim detects Mac
8321 Terminal.app, iTerm2 or mintty, and when the xterm version is 277 or
8322 higher.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008323 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" or "sgr"
8324 automatically, set t_RV to an empty string: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008325 :set t_RV=
8326<
8327 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'*
8328'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999)
8329 global
8330 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines
8331 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is
8332 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number,
8333 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying.
8334
8335 *'ttytype'* *'tty'*
8336'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM)
8337 global
8338 Alias for 'term', see above.
8339
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008340 *'undodir'* *'udir'*
8341'undodir' 'udir' string (default ".")
8342 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008343 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008344 List of directory names for undo files, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaarb230bd52010-05-25 21:02:00 +02008345 See |'backupdir'| for details of the format.
Bram Moolenaar6a244fe2010-05-24 22:02:24 +02008346 "." means using the directory of the file. The undo file name for
8347 "file.txt" is ".file.txt.un~".
8348 For other directories the file name is the full path of the edited
8349 file, with path separators replaced with "%".
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008350 When writing: The first directory that exists is used. "." always
8351 works, no directories after "." will be used for writing.
8352 When reading all entries are tried to find an undo file. The first
8353 undo file that exists is used. When it cannot be read an error is
8354 given, no further entry is used.
8355 See |undo-persistence|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02008356 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8357 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008358
Bram Moolenaar543b7ef2013-06-01 14:50:56 +02008359 *'undofile'* *'noundofile'* *'udf'* *'noudf'*
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008360'undofile' 'udf' boolean (default off)
8361 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008362 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008363 When on, Vim automatically saves undo history to an undo file when
8364 writing a buffer to a file, and restores undo history from the same
8365 file on buffer read.
Bram Moolenaarb230bd52010-05-25 21:02:00 +02008366 The directory where the undo file is stored is specified by 'undodir'.
8367 For more information about this feature see |undo-persistence|.
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02008368 The undo file is not read when 'undoreload' causes the buffer from
8369 before a reload to be saved for undo.
Bram Moolenaar97d62492012-11-15 21:28:22 +01008370 When 'undofile' is turned off the undo file is NOT deleted.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01008371 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008372
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008373 *'undolevels'* *'ul'*
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01008374'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS and Win32)
Bram Moolenaarf5a2fd82013-11-06 05:26:15 +01008375 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008376 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information
Bram Moolenaar5be4cee2019-09-27 19:34:08 +02008377 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used.
8378 Nevertheless, a single change can already use a large amount of memory.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008379 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes
8380 itself: >
8381 set ul=0
8382< But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in
8383 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo.
Bram Moolenaar945e2db2010-06-05 17:43:32 +02008384 Also see |undo-two-ways|.
Bram Moolenaarf5a2fd82013-11-06 05:26:15 +01008385 Set to -1 for no undo at all. You might want to do this only for the
8386 current buffer: >
8387 setlocal ul=-1
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008388< This helps when you run out of memory for a single change.
Bram Moolenaar32efaf62014-11-05 17:02:17 +01008389
8390 The local value is set to -123456 when the global value is to be used.
8391
Bram Moolenaar945e2db2010-06-05 17:43:32 +02008392 Also see |clear-undo|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008393
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02008394 *'undoreload'* *'ur'*
8395'undoreload' 'ur' number (default 10000)
8396 global
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02008397 Save the whole buffer for undo when reloading it. This applies to the
8398 ":e!" command and reloading for when the buffer changed outside of
8399 Vim. |FileChangedShell|
Bram Moolenaar24a98a02017-09-27 22:23:55 +02008400 The save only happens when this option is negative or when the number
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02008401 of lines is smaller than the value of this option.
8402 Set this option to zero to disable undo for a reload.
8403
8404 When saving undo for a reload, any undo file is not read.
8405
8406 Note that this causes the whole buffer to be stored in memory. Set
8407 this option to a lower value if you run out of memory.
8408
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008409 *'updatecount'* *'uc'*
8410'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200)
8411 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008412 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to
8413 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on
8414 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting
8415 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly
8416 mode this option will be initialized to 10000.
8417 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|.
8418 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are
8419 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount'
8420 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted.
8421 Also see |'swapsync'|.
8422 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile"
8423 or "nowrite".
8424
8425 *'updatetime'* *'ut'*
8426'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000)
8427 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008428 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be
8429 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the
8430 |CursorHold| autocommand event.
8431
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008432 *'varsofttabstop'* *'vsts'*
8433'varsofttabstop' 'vsts' string (default "")
8434 local to buffer
8435 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs|
8436 feature}
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008437 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while editing,
8438 such as inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like variable-
8439 width <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mixture of spaces
8440 and <Tab>s is used. Tab widths are separated with commas, with the
8441 final value applying to all subsequent tabs.
8442
8443 For example, when editing assembly language files where statements
Bram Moolenaar6dc819b2018-07-03 16:42:19 +02008444 start in the 9th column and comments in the 41st, it may be useful
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008445 to use the following: >
8446 :set varsofttabstop=8,32,8
Bram Moolenaar6dc819b2018-07-03 16:42:19 +02008447< This will set soft tabstops with 8 and 8 + 32 spaces, and 8 more
8448 for every column thereafter.
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008449
8450 Note that the value of |'softtabstop'| will be ignored while
8451 'varsofttabstop' is set.
8452
8453 *'vartabstop'* *'vts'*
8454'vartabstop' 'vts' string (default "")
8455 local to buffer
8456 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs|
8457 feature}
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008458 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for,
8459 separated by commas. Each value corresponds to one tab, with the
8460 final value applying to all subsequent tabs. For example: >
8461 :set vartabstop=4,20,10,8
8462< This will make the first tab 4 spaces wide, the second 20 spaces,
8463 the third 10 spaces, and all following tabs 8 spaces.
8464
8465 Note that the value of |'tabstop'| will be ignored while 'vartabstop'
8466 is set.
8467
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008468 *'verbose'* *'vbs'*
8469'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0)
8470 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008471 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing.
8472 Currently, these messages are given:
8473 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written.
8474 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed.
Bram Moolenaar647a5302020-05-03 17:01:24 +02008475 >= 4 Shell commands.
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00008476 >= 5 Every searched tags file and include file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008477 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed.
8478 >= 9 Every executed autocommand.
Bram Moolenaar647a5302020-05-03 17:01:24 +02008479 >= 11 Finding items in a path
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008480 >= 12 Every executed function.
8481 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded.
8482 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause.
Bram Moolenaar823654b2020-05-29 23:03:09 +02008483 >= 15 Every executed Ex command from a script (truncated at 200
8484 characters).
Bram Moolenaare7b1ea02020-08-07 19:54:59 +02008485 >= 16 Every executed Ex command.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008486
8487 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|.
8488 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command.
8489
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00008490 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not
8491 displayed.
8492
8493 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'*
8494'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty)
8495 global
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00008496 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name.
8497 When the file exists messages are appended.
8498 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made
Bram Moolenaar80794b12010-06-13 05:20:42 +02008499 empty. Writes are buffered, thus may not show up for some time.
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00008500 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first.
8501 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not
8502 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set.
8503
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008504 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01008505'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga and Win32:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008506 "$VIM/vimfiles/view",
8507 for Unix: "~/.vim/view",
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02008508 for macOS: "$VIM:vimfiles:view"
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01008509 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008510 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008511 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008512 feature}
8513 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|.
8514 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8515 security reasons.
8516
8517 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'*
Bram Moolenaar13e90412017-11-11 18:16:48 +01008518'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor,curdir")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008519 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008520 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008521 feature}
8522 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma separated
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008523 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008524 word save and restore ~
8525 cursor cursor position in file and in window
8526 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
8527 fold options
8528 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
8529 global values for local options)
Bram Moolenaar6e932462014-09-09 18:48:09 +02008530 localoptions same as "options"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008531 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
8532 slashes
8533 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01008534 on MS-Windows
Bram Moolenaar13e90412017-11-11 18:16:48 +01008535 curdir the window-local directory, if set with `:lcd`
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008536
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01008537 "slash" and "unix" are useful on MS-Windows when sharing view files
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008538 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01008539 but the MS-Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008540
8541 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01008542'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for
8543 MS-Windows: '100,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:,
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01008544 for Amiga: '100,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:
8545 for others: '100,<50,s10,h)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008546 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008547 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008548 feature}
8549 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008550 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). Except when 'viminfofile' is
8551 "NONE".
8552 The string should be a comma separated list of parameters, each
8553 consisting of a single character identifying the particular parameter,
8554 followed by a number or string which specifies the value of that
8555 parameter. If a particular character is left out, then the default
8556 value is used for that parameter. The following is a list of the
8557 identifying characters and the effect of their value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008558 CHAR VALUE ~
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008559 *viminfo-!*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008560 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start
8561 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase
8562 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis"
Bram Moolenaar680eeca2010-10-20 17:44:42 +02008563 and "_K_L_M" are not. Nested List and Dict items may not be
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01008564 read back correctly, you end up with an empty item.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008565 *viminfo-quote*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008566 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of
8567 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a
8568 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the
8569 start of a comment!
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008570 *viminfo-%*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008571 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is
8572 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not
8573 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the
Bram Moolenaard042dc82015-11-24 19:18:36 +01008574 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Quickfix
8575 ('buftype'), unlisted ('buflisted'), unnamed and buffers on
8576 removable media (|viminfo-r|) are not saved.
Bram Moolenaar15d0a8c2004-09-06 17:44:46 +00008577 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum
8578 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all
8579 buffers are stored.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008580 *viminfo-'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008581 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks
8582 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when
8583 'viminfo' is non-empty.
8584 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the
8585 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008586 *viminfo-/*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008587 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008588 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008589 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of
8590 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008591 *viminfo-:*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008592 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008593 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008594 *viminfo-<*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008595 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then
8596 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are
8597 saved. '"' is the old name for this item.
8598 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008599 *viminfo-@*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008600 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008601 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008602 *viminfo-c*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008603 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the
8604 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008605 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008606 *viminfo-f*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008607 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0
8608 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008609 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008610 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo").
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008611 *viminfo-h*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008612 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo
8613 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch"
8614 has been used since the last search command.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008615 *viminfo-n*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008616 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008617 the 'n'. Must be at the end of the option! If the
8618 'viminfofile' option is set, that file name overrides the one
8619 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are
Bram Moolenaar063b9d12016-07-09 20:21:48 +02008620 expanded when opening the file, not when setting the option.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008621 *viminfo-r*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008622 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next
8623 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each
8624 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01008625 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-Windows you
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008626 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can
8627 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is
8628 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50
8629 characters.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008630 *viminfo-s*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008631 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are
8632 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default
8633 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text.
8634 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit.
8635
8636 Example: >
8637 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo
8638<
8639 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you
8640 edited.
8641 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be
8642 remembered.
8643 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped.
8644 :0 Command-line history will not be saved.
8645 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo".
8646 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used,
8647 that is, save all of the search history, and also the
8648 previous search and substitute patterns.
8649 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back.
8650 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored.
8651
8652 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to
8653 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically.
8654
8655 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8656 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01008657 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
8658 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008659
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008660 *'viminfofile'* *'vif'*
8661'viminfofile' 'vif' string (default: "")
8662 global
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008663 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
8664 feature}
8665 When non-empty, overrides the file name used for viminfo.
8666 When equal to "NONE" no viminfo file will be read or written.
8667 This option can be set with the |-i| command line flag. The |--clean|
8668 command line flag sets it to "NONE".
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02008669 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8670 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008671
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008672 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'*
8673'virtualedit' 've' string (default "")
Gary Johnson51ad8502021-08-03 18:33:08 +02008674 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008675 A comma separated list of these words:
8676 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode.
8677 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode.
8678 all Allow virtual editing in all modes.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00008679 onemore Allow the cursor to move just past the end of the line
Gary Johnson53ba05b2021-07-26 22:19:10 +02008680 none When used as the local value, do not allow virtual
8681 editing even when the global value is set. When used
8682 as the global value, "none" is the same as "".
8683 NONE Alternative spelling of "none".
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008684
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008685 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00008686 no actual character. This can be halfway into a tab or beyond the end
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008687 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and
8688 editing a table.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00008689 "onemore" is not the same, it will only allow moving the cursor just
8690 after the last character of the line. This makes some commands more
8691 consistent. Previously the cursor was always past the end of the line
8692 if the line was empty. But it is far from Vi compatible. It may also
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008693 break some plugins or Vim scripts. For example because |l| can move
8694 the cursor after the last character. Use with care!
Bram Moolenaar9ba7e172013-07-17 22:37:26 +02008695 Using the `$` command will move to the last character in the line, not
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008696 past it. This may actually move the cursor to the left!
Bram Moolenaar9ba7e172013-07-17 22:37:26 +02008697 The `g$` command will move to the end of the screen line.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00008698 It doesn't make sense to combine "all" with "onemore", but you will
8699 not get a warning for it.
Bram Moolenaar53f7fcc2021-07-28 20:10:16 +02008700 When combined with other words, "none" is ignored.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01008701 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008702
8703 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep*
8704'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off)
8705 global
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008706 Use a visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008707 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted,
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008708 use: >
8709 :set vb t_vb=
8710< If you want a short flash, you can use this on many terminals: >
8711 :set vb t_vb=[?5h$<100>[?5l
8712< Here $<100> specifies the time, you can use a smaller or bigger value
8713 to get a shorter or longer flash.
8714
8715 Note: Vim will limit the bell to once per half a second. This avoids
8716 having to wait for the flashing to finish when there are lots of
8717 bells, e.g. on key repeat. This also happens without 'visualbell'
8718 set.
8719
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008720 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display
8721 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f",
8722 where 40 is the time in msec.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008723
8724 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You
8725 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|.
8726
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008727 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash.
8728 Also see 'errorbells'.
8729
8730 *'warn'* *'nowarn'*
8731'warn' boolean (default on)
8732 global
8733 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer
8734 has been changed.
8735
8736 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'*
8737'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off)
8738 global
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00008739 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008740 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x.
8741 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and
8742 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running.
8743
8744 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'*
8745'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "")
8746 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008747 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the
8748 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in
8749 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys:
8750 char key mode ~
8751 b <BS> Normal and Visual
8752 s <Space> Normal and Visual
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00008753 h "h" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
8754 l "l" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008755 < <Left> Normal and Visual
8756 > <Right> Normal and Visual
8757 ~ "~" Normal
8758 [ <Left> Insert and Replace
8759 ] <Right> Insert and Replace
8760 For example: >
8761 :set ww=<,>,[,]
8762< allows wrap only when cursor keys are used.
8763 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change
8764 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h"
8765 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This
8766 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and
8767 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping
8768 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the
8769 cursor.
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00008770 When 'l' is included and it is used after an operator at the end of a
Bram Moolenaar589edb32019-09-20 14:38:13 +02008771 line (not an empty line) then it will not move to the next line. This
8772 makes "dl", "cl", "yl" etc. work normally.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008773 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
8774 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
8775
8776 *'wildchar'* *'wc'*
8777'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E)
8778 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008779 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the
8780 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008781 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008782 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See
8783 'wildcharm' for that.
Bram Moolenaar34cc7d82021-09-21 20:09:51 +02008784 Some keys will not work, such as CTRL-C, <CR> and Enter.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008785 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: >
Bram Moolenaar34cc7d82021-09-21 20:09:51 +02008786 :set wc=<Tab>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008787< NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
8788 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
8789
8790 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'*
8791'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0))
8792 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008793 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008794 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line
8795 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008796 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that
8797 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: >
8798 :set wcm=<C-Z>
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008799 :cnoremap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008800< Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N.
8801
8802 *'wildignore'* *'wig'*
8803'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "")
8804 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008805 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
8806 feature}
8807 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02008808 patterns is ignored when expanding |wildcards|, completing file or
8809 directory names, and influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and
8810 |globpath()| unless a flag is passed to disable this.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008811 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
8812 Also see 'suffixes'.
8813 Example: >
8814 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj
8815< The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
8816 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
8817 uses another default.
8818
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01008819
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01008820 *'wildignorecase'* *'wic'* *'nowildignorecase'* *'nowic'*
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01008821'wildignorecase' 'wic' boolean (default off)
8822 global
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01008823 When set case is ignored when completing file names and directories.
Bram Moolenaar71afbfe2013-03-19 16:49:16 +01008824 Has no effect when 'fileignorecase' is set.
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01008825 Does not apply when the shell is used to expand wildcards, which
8826 happens when there are special characters.
8827
8828
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008829 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02008830'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008831 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008832 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu|
8833 feature}
8834 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced
8835 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion,
8836 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the
8837 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is
8838 one). Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or
8839 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match.
8840 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is
8841 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode.
Bram Moolenaar26402cb2013-02-20 21:26:00 +01008842 You can check the current mode with |wildmenumode()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008843 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on
8844 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls
8845 as needed.
8846 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used
8847 for selecting a completion.
8848 While the "wildmenu" is active the following keys have special
8849 meanings:
8850
8851 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N)
8852 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a
8853 subdirectory or submenu.
8854 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a
8855 dot: move into a submenu.
8856 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into
8857 parent directory or parent menu.
8858
8859 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|.
8860
8861 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead
8862 of selecting a different match, use this: >
8863 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left>
8864 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right>
8865<
8866 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match
8867 |hl-WildMenu|.
8868
8869 *'wildmode'* *'wim'*
8870'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full")
8871 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008872 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008873 'wildchar'. It is a comma separated list of up to four parts. Each
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00008874 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar'. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008875 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar',
8876 The second part for the second use, etc.
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02008877
8878 Each part consists of a colon separated list consisting of the
8879 following possible values:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008880 "" Complete only the first match.
8881 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match,
8882 the original string is used and then the first match
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02008883 again. Will also start 'wildmenu' if it is enabled.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008884 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't
8885 result in a longer string, use the next part.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008886 "list" When more than one match, list all matches.
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02008887 "lastused" When completing buffer names and more than one buffer
8888 matches, sort buffers by time last used (other than
8889 the current buffer).
8890 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases.
8891
8892 Examples of useful colon-separated values:
8893 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is
8894 enabled. Will not complete to the next full match.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008895 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and
8896 complete first match.
8897 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and
8898 complete till longest common string.
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02008899 "list:lastused" When more than one buffer matches, list all matches
8900 and sort buffers by time last used (other than the
8901 current buffer).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008902
8903 Examples: >
8904 :set wildmode=full
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008905< Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008906 :set wildmode=longest,full
8907< Complete longest common string, then each full match >
8908 :set wildmode=list:full
8909< List all matches and complete each full match >
8910 :set wildmode=list,full
8911< List all matches without completing, then each full match >
8912 :set wildmode=longest,list
8913< Complete longest common string, then list alternatives.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008914 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008915
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00008916 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'*
8917'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "")
8918 global
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00008919 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
8920 feature}
8921 A list of words that change how command line completion is done.
8922 Currently only one word is allowed:
8923 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00008924 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00008925 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are:
8926 d #define
8927 f function
8928 Also see |cmdline-completion|.
8929
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008930 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'*
8931'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu")
8932 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008933 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI}
8934 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT
8935 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the
8936 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and
8937 entering special characters. This option tells what to do:
8938 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be
8939 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be
8940 done with the |:simalt| command.
8941 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key
8942 combinations cannot be mapped.
8943 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008944 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008945 keys can be mapped.
8946 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT
8947 key is never used for the menu.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00008948 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will
8949 select the menu, unless it has been mapped.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008950
Bram Moolenaar4d784b22019-05-25 19:51:39 +02008951 *'wincolor'* *'wcr'*
8952'wincolor' 'wcr' string (default empty)
8953 local to window
8954 Highlight group name to use for this window instead of the Normal
8955 color |hl-Normal|.
8956
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00008957 *'window'* *'wi'*
8958'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1)
8959 global
Bram Moolenaardad44732021-03-31 20:07:33 +02008960 Window height used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one
8961 window and the value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen
8962 will scroll 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00008963 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll
8964 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines.
8965 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than
8966 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1.
Bram Moolenaardad44732021-03-31 20:07:33 +02008967 Note: Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window, use
8968 'lines' for that.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00008969
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008970 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591*
8971'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1)
8972 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008973 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008974 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008975 focus goes to a window that is smaller, its size is increased, at the
8976 cost of the height of other windows.
8977 Set 'winheight' to a small number for normal editing.
8978 Set it to 999 to make the current window fill most of the screen.
8979 Other windows will be only 'winminheight' high. This has the drawback
8980 that ":all" will create only two windows. To avoid "vim -o 1 2 3 4"
8981 to create only two windows, set the option after startup is done,
8982 using the |VimEnter| event: >
8983 au VimEnter * set winheight=999
8984< Minimum value is 1.
8985 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands that change the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008986 height of the current window.
8987 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set
8988 the minimal height for other windows.
8989
8990 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'*
8991'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off)
8992 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008993 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00008994 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. Set by default for the
8995 |preview-window| and |quickfix-window|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008996 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room.
8997
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008998 *'winfixwidth'* *'wfw'* *'nowinfixwidth'* *'nowfw'*
8999'winfixwidth' 'wfw' boolean (default off)
9000 local to window
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00009001 Keep the window width when windows are opened or closed and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00009002 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00009003 The width may be changed anyway when running out of room.
9004
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009005 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'*
9006'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1)
9007 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009008 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window.
9009 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
9010 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a
9011 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when
9012 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.)
9013 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window.
9014 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
9015 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
9016 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable.
9017
9018 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'*
9019'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1)
9020 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009021 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window.
9022 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
9023 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just
9024 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one
9025 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere
9026 to go.)
9027 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window.
9028 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
9029 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
9030 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable.
9031
Bram Moolenaar9e13aa72017-08-16 23:14:08 +02009032 *'winptydll'*
9033'winptydll' string (default "winpty32.dll" or "winpty64.dll")
9034 global
Bram Moolenaar9e13aa72017-08-16 23:14:08 +02009035 {only available when compiled with the |terminal|
9036 feature on MS-Windows}
9037 Specifies the name of the winpty shared library, used for the
Bram Moolenaare7b1ea02020-08-07 19:54:59 +02009038 |:terminal| command. The default depends on whether Vim was built as a
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +02009039 32-bit or 64-bit executable. If not found, "winpty.dll" is tried as
Bram Moolenaar9e13aa72017-08-16 23:14:08 +02009040 a fallback.
9041 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
9042 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
9043 security reasons.
9044
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009045 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592*
9046'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20)
9047 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009048 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard
9049 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If
9050 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of
9051 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
9052 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing.
9053 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
9054 width of the current window.
9055 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set
9056 the minimal width for other windows.
9057
9058 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'*
9059'wrap' boolean (default on)
9060 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009061 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text
9062 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that.
9063 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009064 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap
9065 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009066 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll
9067 horizontally.
9068 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See
9069 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary.
9070 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: >
9071 :set sidescroll=5
9072 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:>
9073< See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01009074 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
9075 on.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009076
9077 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'*
9078'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0)
9079 local to buffer
9080 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping
9081 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted
9082 and inserting continues on the next line.
9083 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause
9084 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible.
9085 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02009086 This option is set to 0 when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste'
9087 is reset.
Bram Moolenaara6c27c42019-05-09 19:16:22 +02009088 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009089
9090 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'*
9091'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385*
9092 global
Bram Moolenaarac6e65f2005-08-29 22:25:38 +00009093 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and
9094 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009095
9096 *'write'* *'nowrite'*
9097'write' boolean (default on)
9098 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009099 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed.
9100 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009101 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009102 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires
9103 writing a temporary file.
9104
9105 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'*
9106'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off)
9107 global
9108 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override.
9109
9110 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'*
9111'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off
9112 otherwise)
9113 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009114 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after
9115 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is
Bram Moolenaar1aeaf8c2012-05-18 13:46:39 +02009116 also on.
9117 WARNING: Switching this option off means that when Vim fails to write
9118 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
9119 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only reset
9120 this option if your file system is almost full and it makes the write
9121 fail (and make sure not to exit Vim until the write was successful).
9122 See |backup-table| for another explanation.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009123 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01009124 Depending on 'backupcopy' the backup is a new file or the original
9125 file renamed (and a new file is written).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009126 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is
9127 set.
9128
9129 *'writedelay'* *'wd'*
9130'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0)
9131 global
Bram Moolenaar802a0d92016-06-26 16:17:58 +02009132 The number of milliseconds to wait for each character sent to the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009133 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01009134 one. For debugging purposes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009135
Bram Moolenaar91f84f62018-07-29 15:07:52 +02009136 vim:tw=78:ts=8:noet:ft=help:norl: